3 @setfilename coreutils.info
5 @settitle GNU Coreutils @value{VERSION}
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @set txicodequoteundirected
8 @set txicodequotebacktick
13 @include constants.texi
15 @c Define new indices.
19 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
29 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
30 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options.
31 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
32 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
35 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
36 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
37 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
39 @dircategory Individual utilities
41 * arch: (coreutils)arch invocation. Print machine hardware name.
42 * b2sum: (coreutils)b2sum invocation. Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
43 * base32: (coreutils)base32 invocation. Base32 encode/decode data.
44 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
45 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
46 * basenc: (coreutils)basenc invocation. Encoding/decoding of data.
47 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
48 * chcon: (coreutils)chcon invocation. Change SELinux CTX of files.
49 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
50 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change access permissions.
51 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners and groups.
52 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
53 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
54 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
55 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
56 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
57 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
58 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
59 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
60 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system usage.
61 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
62 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
63 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip last file name component.
64 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report file usage.
65 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
66 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
67 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
68 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
69 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
70 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
71 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
72 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
73 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
74 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
75 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
76 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
77 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
78 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy files and set attributes.
79 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
80 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
81 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
82 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
83 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
84 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
85 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
86 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
87 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
88 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
89 * mktemp: (coreutils)mktemp invocation. Create temporary files.
90 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
91 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
92 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
93 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
94 * nproc: (coreutils)nproc invocation. Print the number of processors.
95 * numfmt: (coreutils)numfmt invocation. Reformat numbers.
96 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
97 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
98 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
99 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
100 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
101 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
102 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
103 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
104 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
105 * realpath: (coreutils)realpath invocation. Print resolved file names.
106 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
107 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
108 * runcon: (coreutils)runcon invocation. Run in specified SELinux CTX.
109 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
110 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
111 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
112 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
113 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
114 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
115 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
116 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into pieces.
117 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
118 * stdbuf: (coreutils)stdbuf invocation. Modify stdio buffering.
119 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
120 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
121 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Sync files to stable storage.
122 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
123 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
124 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
125 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
126 * timeout: (coreutils)timeout invocation. Run with time limit.
127 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
128 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
129 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
130 * truncate: (coreutils)truncate invocation. Shrink/extend size of a file.
131 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
132 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
133 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
134 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
135 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
136 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
137 * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. Print uptime and load.
138 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
139 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
140 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
141 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
142 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
143 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
147 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the GNU core
148 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
150 Copyright @copyright{} 1994--2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
153 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
154 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
155 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
156 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
157 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
158 Free Documentation License''.
163 @title GNU @code{Coreutils}
164 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
165 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
166 @author David MacKenzie et al.
169 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
182 @cindex core utilities
183 @cindex text utilities
184 @cindex shell utilities
185 @cindex file utilities
188 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors
189 * Common options:: Common options
190 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od base32 base64 basenc
191 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
192 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
193 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum b2sum md5sum sha1sum sha2
194 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
195 * Operating on fields:: cut paste join
196 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
197 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
198 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
199 * Special file types:: mkdir rmdir unlink mkfifo mknod ln link readlink
200 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
201 * File space usage:: df du stat sync truncate
202 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
203 * Conditions:: false true test expr
205 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk mktemp realpath
206 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
207 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
208 * System context:: date arch nproc uname hostname hostid uptime
209 * SELinux context:: chcon runcon
210 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup stdbuf timeout
211 * Process control:: kill
213 * Numeric operations:: factor numfmt seq
214 * File permissions:: Access modes
215 * File timestamps:: File timestamp issues
216 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
217 * Version sort ordering:: Details on version-sort algorithm
218 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy
219 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
220 * Concept index:: General index
223 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
227 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure
228 * Backup options:: Backup options
229 * Block size:: Block size
230 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation
231 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals
232 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
233 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
234 * Target directory:: Target directory
235 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
236 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
237 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
238 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
239 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation
241 Output of entire files
243 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files
244 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse
245 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files
246 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats
247 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
248 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data
249 * basenc invocation:: Transform data into printable data
251 Formatting file contents
253 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text
254 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing
255 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
257 Output of parts of files
259 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files
260 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files
261 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
262 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces
266 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts
267 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts
268 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
269 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
270 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests
271 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests
272 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests
274 Operating on sorted files
276 * sort invocation:: Sort text files
277 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files
278 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files
279 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line
280 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents
281 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort
283 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
285 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior
286 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations
287 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection
288 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields
289 * Compatibility in ptx:: The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
293 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines
294 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files
295 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field
297 Operating on characters
299 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
300 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces
301 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs
303 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
305 * Character arrays:: Specifying arrays of characters
306 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another
307 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters
311 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
312 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
313 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
314 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
316 @command{ls}: List directory contents
318 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
319 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
320 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
321 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
322 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
326 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
327 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
328 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
329 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
330 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
331 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
335 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
336 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
337 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
338 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
339 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
340 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
341 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
342 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
344 Changing file attributes
346 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
347 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
348 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
349 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
353 * df invocation:: Report file system space usage
354 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
355 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
356 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
357 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file
361 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
362 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
363 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
367 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
368 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
369 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
370 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
372 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
374 * File type tests:: File type tests
375 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
376 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
377 * String tests:: String tests
378 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
380 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
382 * String expressions:: @code{+ : match substr index length}
383 * Numeric expressions:: @code{+ - * / %}
384 * Relations for expr:: @code{| & < <= = == != >= >}
385 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
389 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
391 File name manipulation
393 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
394 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component
395 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability
396 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory
397 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names
401 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
402 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
403 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
404 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
406 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
408 * Control:: Control settings
409 * Input:: Input settings
410 * Output:: Output settings
411 * Local:: Local settings
412 * Combination:: Combination settings
413 * Characters:: Special characters
414 * Special:: Special settings
418 * id invocation:: Print user identity
419 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
420 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
421 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
422 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
423 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
427 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name
428 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
429 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors
430 * uname invocation:: Print system information
431 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
432 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier
433 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load
435 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
437 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
438 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
439 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
440 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
441 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock
442 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time
443 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings
444 * Examples of date:: Examples
448 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
449 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
451 Modified command invocation
453 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
454 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
455 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
456 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
457 * stdbuf invocation:: Run a command with modified I/O buffering
458 * timeout invocation:: Run a command with a time limit
462 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
466 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
470 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
471 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers
472 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
477 * File timestamps:: File timestamp issues
481 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits
482 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits
483 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers
484 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories
488 * General date syntax:: Common rules
489 * Calendar date items:: @samp{14 Nov 2022}
490 * Time of day items:: @samp{9:02pm}
491 * Time zone items:: @samp{UTC}, @samp{-0700}, @samp{+0900}, @dots{}
492 * Combined date and time of day items:: @samp{2022-11-14T21:02:42,000000-0500}
493 * Day of week items:: @samp{Monday} and others
494 * Relative items in date strings:: @samp{next tuesday, 2 years ago}
495 * Pure numbers in date strings:: @samp{20221114}, @samp{2102}
496 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @samp{@@1668477762}
497 * Specifying time zone rules:: @samp{TZ="America/New_York"}, @samp{TZ="UTC0"}
498 * Authors of parse_datetime:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
500 Version sorting order
502 * Version sort overview::
503 * Version sort implementation::
504 * Differences from Debian version sort::
505 * Advanced version sort topics::
507 Opening the software toolbox
509 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
510 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
511 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
512 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
513 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
514 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
515 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
519 * GNU Free Documentation License:: Copying and sharing this manual
526 @chapter Introduction
528 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
529 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
530 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire GNU community
534 The GNU utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
536 @cindex bugs, reporting
538 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}.
539 Include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
540 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
541 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong.
543 If you have a problem with @command{sort} or @command{date}, try using the
544 @option{--debug} option, as it can often help find and fix problems without
545 having to wait for an answer to a bug report. If the debug output
546 does not suffice to fix the problem on your own, please compress and
547 attach it to the rest of your bug report.
549 Although diffs are welcome,
550 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
551 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
557 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
560 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
561 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
562 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
563 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
564 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
565 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
566 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
567 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
568 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
569 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
570 insights to the overall process.
573 @chapter Common options
577 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
580 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
581 @cindex backups, making
582 @xref{Backup options}.
583 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
586 @macro optBackupSuffix
587 @item -S @var{suffix}
588 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
591 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
592 @xref{Backup options}.
595 @macro optTargetDirectory
596 @item -t @var{directory}
597 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
599 @opindex --target-directory
600 @cindex target directory
601 @cindex destination directory
602 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
603 @xref{Target directory}.
606 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
608 @itemx --no-target-directory
610 @opindex --no-target-directory
611 @cindex target directory
612 @cindex destination directory
613 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
614 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
618 @cindex output NUL-byte-terminated lines
619 Output a zero byte (ASCII NUL) at the end of each line,
620 rather than a newline. This option enables other programs to parse the
621 output even when that output would contain data with embedded newlines.
640 @macro optZeroTerminated
642 @itemx --zero-terminated
644 @opindex --zero-terminated
645 @cindex process zero-terminated items
646 Delimit items with a zero byte rather than a newline (ASCII LF).
647 I.e., treat input as items separated by ASCII NUL
648 and terminate output items with ASCII NUL.
649 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
650 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
651 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
652 or other special characters).
659 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
660 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
661 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
662 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
663 @option{--human-readable} option if
664 you prefer powers of 1024.
667 @macro optHumanReadable
669 @itemx --human-readable
671 @opindex --human-readable
672 @cindex human-readable output
673 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
674 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
675 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
676 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
679 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
680 @item --strip-trailing-slashes
681 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
682 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
683 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
684 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
687 @macro mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{cmd}
688 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
689 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
690 Due to shell aliases and built-in @command{\cmd\} functions, using an
691 unadorned @command{\cmd\} interactively or in a script may get you
692 different functionality than that described here. Invoke it via
693 @command{env} (i.e., @code{env \cmd\ @dots{}}) to avoid interference
698 @macro multiplierSuffixes{varName}
699 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
700 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
702 @samp{b} => 512 ("blocks")
703 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
704 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
705 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
706 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
707 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
708 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
710 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y},
711 @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}.
712 Binary prefixes can be used, too: @samp{KiB}=@samp{K}, @samp{MiB}=@samp{M},
716 @c FIXME: same as above, but no ``blocks'' line.
717 @macro multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{varName}
718 @var{\varName\} may be, or may be an integer optionally followed by,
719 one of the following multiplicative suffixes:
721 @samp{KB} => 1000 (KiloBytes)
722 @samp{K} => 1024 (KibiBytes)
723 @samp{MB} => 1000*1000 (MegaBytes)
724 @samp{M} => 1024*1024 (MebiBytes)
725 @samp{GB} => 1000*1000*1000 (GigaBytes)
726 @samp{G} => 1024*1024*1024 (GibiBytes)
728 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y},
729 @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}.
730 Binary prefixes can be used, too: @samp{KiB}=@samp{K}, @samp{MiB}=@samp{M},
734 @cindex common options
736 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
737 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
738 described here. (In fact, every GNU program accepts (or should accept)
741 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
742 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
743 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
744 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
745 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
746 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
747 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
749 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
750 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
751 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
752 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
753 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
754 specify a command that itself contains options.
756 Most programs that accept long options recognize unambiguous
757 abbreviations of those options. For example, @samp{rmdir
758 --ignore-fail-on-non-empty} can be invoked as @samp{rmdir
759 --ignore-fail} or even @samp{rmdir --i}. Ambiguous options, such as
760 @samp{ls --h}, are identified as such.
762 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
763 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument. For
764 these programs, abbreviations of the long options are not always recognized.
771 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
775 @cindex version number, finding
776 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
780 @cindex option delimiter
781 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
782 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
783 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
787 @cindex standard input
788 @cindex standard output
789 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
790 stands for a file operand, and some tools treat it as standard input, or as
791 standard output if that is clear from the context. For example, @samp{sort -}
792 reads from standard input, and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}. Unless
793 otherwise specified, a @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
797 Items shared between some programs:
799 * Backup options:: @option{-b} @option{-S}.
800 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and @option{--block-size}.
801 * Signal specifications:: Specifying signals with @option{--signal}.
802 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp, chown, chroot, id: user and group syntax
803 * Random sources:: @option{--random-source}.
804 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory.
805 * Trailing slashes:: @option{--strip-trailing-slashes}.
806 * Traversing symlinks:: @option{-H}, @option{-L}, or @option{-P}.
807 * Treating / specially:: @option{--preserve-root} and the converse.
808 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @dots{}
810 Items applicable to all programs:
812 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
813 * Floating point:: Floating point number representation.
814 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the POSIX standard.
815 * Multi-call invocation:: Multi-call program invocation.
820 @section Backup options
822 @cindex backup options
824 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
825 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
826 before writing new versions.
827 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
828 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
833 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
836 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
837 @cindex backups, making
838 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
839 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
840 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
841 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
842 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
843 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
844 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
846 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
847 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
849 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
850 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
851 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
852 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
853 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
858 @opindex none @r{backup method}
863 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
864 Always make numbered backups.
868 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
869 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
874 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
875 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
876 confused with @samp{none}.
880 @item -S @var{suffix}
881 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
884 @cindex backup suffix
885 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
886 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
887 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
888 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
889 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
898 Some GNU programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
899 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
900 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
901 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
902 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
904 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
907 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
908 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
909 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
910 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
912 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
913 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
918 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
919 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
920 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
923 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
924 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
927 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
928 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
929 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
930 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
931 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
934 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
935 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
936 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
941 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
942 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
943 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
946 @cindex human-readable output
949 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
950 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
951 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
952 that are upward compatible with the
953 @uref{http://www.bipm.org/en/publications/si-brochure/chapter3.html,
955 for decimal multiples and with the
956 @uref{https://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, ISO/IEC 80000-13
957 (formerly IEC 60027-2) prefixes} for binary multiples.
959 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
960 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
961 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
962 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
963 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
966 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
967 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
968 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
969 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
970 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
971 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
974 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
975 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
976 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
977 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
978 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
979 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
980 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
982 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
983 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
984 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
987 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Q}
988 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
992 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
993 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
997 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
998 kibibyte: @math{2^{10} = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
999 @samp{k} and the ISO/IEC 80000-13 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
1000 POSIX use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
1002 @cindex megabyte, definition of
1003 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
1006 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
1007 mebibyte: @math{2^{20} = 1,048,576}.
1009 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
1010 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
1013 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
1014 gibibyte: @math{2^{30} = 1,073,741,824}.
1016 @cindex terabyte, definition of
1017 terabyte: @math{10^{12} = 1,000,000,000,000}.
1020 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
1021 tebibyte: @math{2^{40} = 1,099,511,627,776}.
1023 @cindex petabyte, definition of
1024 petabyte: @math{10^{15} = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
1027 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
1028 pebibyte: @math{2^{50} = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
1030 @cindex exabyte, definition of
1031 exabyte: @math{10^{18} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1034 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
1035 exbibyte: @math{2^{60} = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
1037 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
1038 zettabyte: @math{10^{21} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
1041 zebibyte: @math{2^{70} = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
1043 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
1044 yottabyte: @math{10^{24} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1047 yobibyte: @math{2^{80} = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
1049 @cindex ronnabyte, definition of
1050 ronnabyte: @math{10^{27} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1053 robibyte: @math{2^{90} = 1,237,940,039,285,380,274,899,124,224}.
1055 @cindex quettabyte, definition of
1056 quettabyte: @math{10^{30} = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
1059 quebibyte: @math{2^{100} = 1,267,650,600,228,229,401,496,703,205,376}.
1064 @opindex --block-size
1065 @opindex --human-readable
1068 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
1069 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
1070 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
1071 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
1072 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
1073 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
1074 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}. Note for @command{ls}
1075 the @option{-k} option does not control the display of the
1076 apparent file sizes, whereas the @option{--block-size} option does.
1078 @node Signal specifications
1079 @section Signal specifications
1080 @cindex signals, specifying
1082 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
1083 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
1084 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
1085 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored. The following signal names
1086 and numbers are supported on all POSIX compliant systems:
1092 2. Terminal interrupt.
1098 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
1106 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
1107 numbers. All systems conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001 also
1108 support the following signals:
1112 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
1114 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
1116 Continue executing, if stopped.
1118 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
1120 Illegal Instruction.
1122 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
1124 Invalid memory reference.
1126 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
1130 Background process attempting read.
1132 Background process attempting write.
1134 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
1136 User-defined signal 1.
1138 User-defined signal 2.
1142 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XSI extension
1143 also support the following signals:
1149 Profiling timer expired.
1153 Trace/breakpoint trap.
1155 Virtual timer expired.
1157 CPU time limit exceeded.
1159 File size limit exceeded.
1163 POSIX 1003.1-2001 systems that support the XRT extension
1164 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
1165 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
1167 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
1168 @section chown, chgrp, chroot, id: Disambiguating user names and IDs
1169 @cindex user names, disambiguating
1170 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
1171 @cindex group names, disambiguating
1172 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
1173 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
1175 Since the @var{user} and @var{group} arguments to these commands
1176 may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
1178 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
1179 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID@?
1180 (Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.)
1181 POSIX requires that these commands
1182 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
1183 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID@.
1184 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
1185 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
1186 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
1187 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
1188 1000 -- not what you intended.
1190 GNU @command{chown}, @command{chgrp}, @command{chroot}, and @command{id}
1191 provide a way to work around this, that at the same time may result in a
1192 significant performance improvement by eliminating a database look-up.
1193 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
1194 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
1198 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
1202 The name look-up process is skipped for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
1203 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
1204 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
1206 @node Random sources
1207 @section Sources of random data
1209 @cindex random sources
1211 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
1212 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
1213 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
1214 make this selection.
1216 By default these commands use an internal pseudo-random generator
1217 initialized by a small amount of entropy, but can be directed to use
1218 an external source with the @option{--random-source=@var{file}} option.
1219 An error is reported if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes.
1221 For example, the device file @file{/dev/urandom} could be used as the
1222 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
1223 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
1224 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
1225 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
1226 cryptographically secure pseudo-random number generator. But be aware
1227 that this device is not designed for bulk random data generation
1228 and is relatively slow.
1230 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
1231 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
1232 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
1233 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
1236 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
1237 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1238 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1240 Rather than depending on a file, one can generate a reproducible
1241 arbitrary amount of pseudo-random data given a seed value, using
1248 openssl enc -aes-256-ctr -pass pass:"$seed" -nosalt \
1249 </dev/zero 2>/dev/null
1252 shuf -i1-100 --random-source=<(get_seeded_random 42)
1255 @node Target directory
1256 @section Target directory
1258 @cindex target directory
1260 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1261 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1262 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1263 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1264 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1265 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1266 allow more fine-grained control:
1271 @itemx --no-target-directory
1272 @opindex --no-target-directory
1273 @cindex target directory
1274 @cindex destination directory
1275 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1276 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1277 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1278 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1279 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1280 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1281 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1282 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1283 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1285 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1286 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1287 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1289 @item -t @var{directory}
1290 @itemx --target-directory=@var{directory}
1291 @opindex --target-directory
1292 @cindex target directory
1293 @cindex destination directory
1294 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1297 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1298 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1299 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1300 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1301 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1303 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1304 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1305 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1306 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1307 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1308 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1309 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1310 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1313 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1314 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1315 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1316 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1319 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1322 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1323 If you use the GNU @command{find} program, you can move those
1324 files too, with this command:
1327 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1331 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1332 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1333 some other special characters.
1334 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1335 GNU @command{find} and GNU @command{xargs}:
1338 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1339 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1346 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1347 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1348 options cannot be combined.
1350 @node Trailing slashes
1351 @section Trailing slashes
1353 @cindex trailing slashes
1355 Some GNU programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1356 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1357 operating on it. The @option{--strip-trailing-slashes} option enables
1360 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1361 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1362 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1363 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1364 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1365 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1366 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1367 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1368 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1369 be the default, it is required by POSIX and is consistent with
1370 other parts of that standard.
1372 @node Traversing symlinks
1373 @section Traversing symlinks
1375 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1377 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1378 @c FIXME: note that 'du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1379 @c different meaning.
1380 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1381 option is also specified.
1382 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1384 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1385 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1386 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1388 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1389 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1390 a symlink or its referent.
1397 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse if on the command line
1398 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1399 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1406 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1407 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1408 that is encountered.
1411 @c Append the following warning to -L where appropriate (e.g. chown).
1412 @macro warnOptDerefWithRec
1414 Combining this dereferencing option with the @option{--recursive} option
1415 may create a security risk:
1416 During the traversal of the directory tree, an attacker may be able to
1417 introduce a symlink to an arbitrary target; when the tool reaches that,
1418 the operation will be performed on the target of that symlink,
1419 possibly allowing the attacker to escalate privileges.
1428 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1429 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1430 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1431 or @option{-P} is specified.
1438 @node Treating / specially
1439 @section Treating @file{/} specially
1441 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1442 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1443 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1444 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1445 legitimate uses for such a command,
1446 GNU @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1447 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1448 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1449 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1450 @option{--preserve-root} option, is safer for most purposes.
1452 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1453 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1454 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1455 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1456 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1457 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1458 interrupt them. Tradition and POSIX require these commands
1459 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1460 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1461 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1462 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1464 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1465 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1466 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1468 @node Special built-in utilities
1469 @section Special built-in utilities
1471 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1472 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1473 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1474 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1475 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1476 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1479 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1480 by POSIX 1003.1-2004.
1483 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1484 return set shift times trap unset}
1487 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1488 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1489 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1491 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1492 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1493 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1494 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1498 @section Exit status
1501 An exit status of zero indicates success,
1502 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
1505 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
1506 that can be used to change how other commands work.
1507 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
1508 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value -- typically
1509 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as POSIX
1510 requires only that it be nonzero.
1512 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
1513 other exit status values and a few associate different
1514 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
1515 Here are the exceptions:
1516 @c You can generate the following list with:
1517 @c grep initialize_exit_failure src/*.c | cut -f1 -d: |
1518 @c sed -n 's|src/\(.*\)\.c|@command{\1},|p' | sort | fmt
1519 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr}, @command{ls},
1520 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{numfmt}, @command{printenv},
1521 @command{runcon}, @command{sort}, @command{stdbuf}, @command{test},
1522 @command{timeout}, @command{tty}.
1524 @node Floating point
1525 @section Floating point numbers
1526 @cindex floating point
1527 @cindex IEEE floating point
1529 Commands that accept or produce floating point numbers employ the
1530 floating point representation of the underlying system, and suffer
1531 from rounding error, overflow, and similar floating-point issues.
1532 Almost all modern systems use IEEE-754 floating point, and it is
1533 typically portable to assume IEEE-754 behavior these days. IEEE-754
1534 has positive and negative infinity, distinguishes positive from
1535 negative zero, and uses special values called NaNs to represent
1536 invalid computations such as dividing zero by itself. For more
1537 information, please see David Goldberg's paper
1538 @uref{https://@/docs.oracle.com/@/cd/@/E19957-01/@/806-3568/@/ncg_goldberg.html,
1539 What Every Computer Scientist Should Know About Floating-Point Arithmetic}.
1541 Commands that accept floating point numbers as options, operands or
1542 input use the standard C functions @code{strtod} and @code{strtold} to
1543 convert from text to floating point numbers. These floating point
1544 numbers therefore can use scientific notation like @code{1.0e-34} and
1545 @code{-10e100}. Commands that parse floating point also understand
1546 case-insensitive @code{inf}, @code{infinity}, and @code{NaN}, although
1547 whether such values are useful depends on the command in question.
1548 Modern C implementations also accept hexadecimal floating point
1549 numbers such as @code{-0x.ep-3}, which stands for @minus{}14/16 times
1550 @math{2^-3}, which equals @minus{}0.109375. @xref{Parsing of
1551 Floats,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
1554 Normally the @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point
1555 character. However, some commands' descriptions specify that they
1556 accept numbers in either the current or the C locale; for example,
1557 they treat @samp{3.14} like @samp{3,14} if the current locale uses
1558 comma as a decimal point.
1561 @node Standards conformance
1562 @section Standards conformance
1564 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1565 In a few cases, the GNU utilities' default behavior is
1566 incompatible with the POSIX standard. To suppress these
1567 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1568 variable. Unless you are checking for POSIX conformance, you
1569 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1571 Newer versions of POSIX are occasionally incompatible with older
1572 versions. For example, older versions of POSIX required the
1573 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1574 fields in each input line, but in POSIX 1003.1-2001
1575 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1576 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1577 sort. To complicate things further, POSIX 1003.1-2008 allows an
1578 implementation to have either the old or the new behavior.
1580 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1581 The GNU utilities normally conform to the version of POSIX
1582 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1583 different version of POSIX, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1584 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1585 the year and month the standard was adopted. Three values are currently
1586 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1587 POSIX 1003.2-1992, @samp{200112} stands for POSIX
1588 1003.1-2001, and @samp{200809} stands for POSIX 1003.1-2008.
1589 For example, if you have a POSIX 1003.1-2001 system but are running software
1590 containing traditional usage like @samp{sort +1} or @samp{tail +10},
1591 you can work around the compatibility problems by setting
1592 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=200809} in your environment.
1594 @c This node is named "Multi-call invocation", not the usual
1595 @c "coreutils invocation", so that shell commands like
1596 @c 'info coreutils "touch invocation"' work as expected.
1597 @node Multi-call invocation
1598 @section @command{coreutils}: Multi-call program
1602 @cindex calling combined multi-call program
1604 The @command{coreutils} command invokes an individual utility, either
1605 implicitly selected by the last component of the name used to invoke
1606 @command{coreutils}, or explicitly with the
1607 @option{--coreutils-prog} option. Synopsis:
1610 coreutils @option{--coreutils-prog=PROGRAM} @dots{}
1613 The @command{coreutils} command is not installed by default, so
1614 portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
1616 @node Output of entire files
1617 @chapter Output of entire files
1619 @cindex output of entire files
1620 @cindex entire files, output of
1622 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1626 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1627 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1628 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1629 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1630 * base32 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1631 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1632 * basenc invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1635 @node cat invocation
1636 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1639 @cindex concatenate and write files
1640 @cindex copying files
1642 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1643 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1646 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1649 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1657 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1660 @itemx --number-nonblank
1662 @opindex --number-nonblank
1663 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1667 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1672 @opindex --show-ends
1673 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1674 The @code{\r\n} combination is shown as @samp{^M$}.
1680 Number all output lines, starting with 1. This option is ignored
1681 if @option{-b} is in effect.
1684 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1686 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1687 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1688 @cindex squeezing blank lines
1689 Suppress repeated adjacent blank lines; output just one empty line
1694 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1699 @opindex --show-tabs
1700 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1704 Ignored; for POSIX compatibility.
1707 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1709 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1710 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1711 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1716 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1717 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1718 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1719 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1720 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1721 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1722 if standard output is a terminal.
1729 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1732 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1737 @node tac invocation
1738 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1741 @cindex reversing files
1743 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1744 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1745 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1748 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1751 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1752 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1753 the record that it follows in the file.
1755 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1763 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1764 precedes in the file.
1770 Treat the separator string as a regular expression.
1772 @item -s @var{separator}
1773 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1775 @opindex --separator
1776 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1777 Note an empty @var{separator} is treated as a zero byte.
1778 I.e., input and output items are delimited with ASCII NUL.
1782 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1783 @command{tac} reads and writes in binary mode.
1790 # Reverse a file character by character.
1796 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1799 @cindex numbering lines
1800 @cindex line numbering
1802 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1803 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1804 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1807 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1810 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1811 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) page sections;
1812 by default, the line number is reset to 1 at each logical page section.
1813 @command{nl} treats all of the input files as a single document;
1814 it does not reset line numbers or logical pages between files.
1816 @cindex headers, numbering
1817 @cindex body, numbering
1818 @cindex footers, numbering
1819 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1820 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1821 style from the others.
1823 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1824 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1835 The characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1836 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern
1837 of each string cannot be changed.
1839 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1840 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1841 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1842 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1844 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1848 @item -b @var{style}
1849 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1851 @opindex --body-numbering
1852 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1853 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1854 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1855 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1861 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1863 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1865 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1866 expression @var{bre}.
1867 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1871 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1873 @opindex --section-delimiter
1874 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1875 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1876 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1877 As a GNU extension more than two characters can be specified,
1878 and also if @var{cd} is empty (@option{-d ''}), then section
1879 matching is disabled.
1880 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1881 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1883 @item -f @var{style}
1884 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1886 @opindex --footer-numbering
1887 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1889 @item -h @var{style}
1890 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1892 @opindex --header-numbering
1893 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1895 @item -i @var{number}
1896 @itemx --line-increment=@var{number}
1898 @opindex --line-increment
1899 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1900 @var{number} can be negative to decrement.
1902 @item -l @var{number}
1903 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1905 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1906 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1907 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1908 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1909 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1910 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1911 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1914 @item -n @var{format}
1915 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1917 @opindex --number-format
1918 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1922 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1923 left justified, no leading zeros;
1925 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1926 right justified, no leading zeros;
1928 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1929 right justified, leading zeros.
1933 @itemx --no-renumber
1935 @opindex --no-renumber
1936 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1938 @item -s @var{string}
1939 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1941 @opindex --number-separator
1942 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1943 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1945 @item -v @var{number}
1946 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1948 @opindex --starting-line-number
1949 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1950 The starting @var{number} can be negative.
1952 @item -w @var{number}
1953 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1955 @opindex --number-width
1956 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1964 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1967 @cindex octal dump of files
1968 @cindex hex dump of files
1969 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1970 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1972 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1973 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1977 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1978 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1979 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}]@c
1980 [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1983 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1984 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1985 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1986 printed as a single octal number.
1988 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1989 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1990 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1991 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1992 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1993 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1994 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1996 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1997 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1998 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1999 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
2002 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2006 @item -A @var{radix}
2007 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
2009 @opindex --address-radix
2010 @cindex radix for file offsets
2011 @cindex file offset radix
2012 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
2013 be one of the following:
2023 none (do not print offsets).
2026 The default is octal.
2028 @item --endian=@var{order}
2030 @cindex byte-swapping
2032 Reorder input bytes, to handle inputs with differing byte orders,
2033 or to provide consistent output independent of the endian convention
2034 of the current system. Swapping is performed according to the
2035 specified @option{--type} size and endian @var{order}, which can be
2036 @samp{little} or @samp{big}.
2038 @item -j @var{bytes}
2039 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
2041 @opindex --skip-bytes
2042 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
2043 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
2044 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
2046 @multiplierSuffixes{bytes}
2048 @item -N @var{bytes}
2049 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
2051 @opindex --read-bytes
2052 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
2053 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
2055 @item -S @var{bytes}
2056 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
2059 @cindex string constants, outputting
2060 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
2061 least @var{bytes} consecutive printable characters,
2062 followed by a zero byte (ASCII NUL).
2063 Prefixes and suffixes on @var{bytes} are interpreted as for the
2066 If @var{bytes} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
2069 @itemx --format=@var{type}
2072 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
2073 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
2074 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
2075 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
2076 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
2077 in the order that you specified.
2079 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
2080 of the single byte character representation of the printable characters
2081 to the output line generated by the type specification.
2085 named character, ignoring high-order bit
2087 printable single byte character, C backslash escape
2088 or a 3 digit octal sequence
2092 floating point (@pxref{Floating point})
2101 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
2102 newline, and @samp{nul} for a zero byte. Only the least significant
2103 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
2104 Type @code{c} outputs
2105 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
2108 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
2109 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
2110 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
2111 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
2112 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
2113 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
2114 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
2127 For floating point (@code{f}):
2139 @itemx --output-duplicates
2141 @opindex --output-duplicates
2142 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
2143 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
2144 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
2145 indicate the elision.
2148 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
2151 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
2152 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
2155 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
2156 omitted, the default is 32.
2160 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
2161 GNU @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
2162 specification options. These options accumulate.
2168 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
2172 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
2176 Output as printable single byte characters, C backslash escapes
2177 or 3 digit octal sequences. Equivalent to @samp{-t c}.
2181 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
2185 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
2189 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
2193 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
2197 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
2201 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
2205 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
2208 @opindex --traditional
2209 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
2210 accepted. The following syntax:
2213 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
2217 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
2218 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
2219 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
2220 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
2221 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
2229 @node base32 invocation
2230 @section @command{base32}: Transform data into printable data
2233 @cindex base32 encoding
2235 @command{base32} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2236 into (or from) base32 encoded form. The base32 encoded form uses
2237 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2238 The usage and options of this command are precisely the
2239 same as for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2240 For more general encoding functionality see @ref{basenc invocation}.
2243 @node base64 invocation
2244 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data
2247 @cindex base64 encoding
2249 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2250 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
2251 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2255 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2256 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2259 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
2260 The base32 encoding expands data to roughly 160% of the original.
2261 The format conforms to
2262 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648, RFC 4648}.
2264 For more general encoding functionality see @ref{basenc invocation}.
2266 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2271 @itemx --wrap=@var{cols}
2275 @cindex column to wrap data after
2276 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{cols} characters. This must be
2279 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
2280 disable line wrapping altogether.
2286 @cindex Decode base64 data
2287 @cindex Base64 decoding
2288 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
2289 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
2290 output will be the original data.
2293 @itemx --ignore-garbage
2295 @opindex --ignore-garbage
2296 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
2297 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
2298 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
2299 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
2305 @node basenc invocation
2306 @section @command{basenc}: Transform data into printable data
2309 @cindex base32 encoding
2311 @command{basenc} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
2312 into (or from) various common encoding forms. The encoded form uses
2313 printable ASCII characters to represent binary data.
2318 basenc @var{encoding} [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2319 basenc @var{encoding} --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
2322 The @var{encoding} argument is required. If @var{file} is omitted,
2323 @command{basenc} reads from standard input.
2324 The @option{-w/--wrap},@option{-i/--ignore-garbage},
2325 @option{-d/--decode} options of this command are precisely the same as
2326 for @command{base64}. @xref{base64 invocation}.
2329 Supported @var{encoding}s are:
2335 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base64 form.
2336 The format conforms to
2337 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648#section-4, RFC 4648#4}.
2338 Equivalent to the @command{base64} command.
2341 @opindex --base64url
2342 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) file-and-url-safe
2343 base64 form (using @samp{_} and @samp{-} instead of @samp{+} and @samp{/}).
2344 The format conforms to
2345 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648#section-5, RFC 4648#5}.
2349 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base32 form.
2350 The encoded data uses the @samp{ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ234567=} characters.
2351 The format conforms to
2352 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648#section-6, RFC 4648#6}.
2353 Equivalent to the @command{base32} command.
2356 @opindex --base32hex
2357 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) Extended Hex Alphabet
2358 base32 form. The encoded data uses the
2359 @samp{0123456789ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUV=} characters. The format conforms to
2360 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648#section-7, RFC 4648#7}.
2364 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) base16 (hexadecimal)
2365 form. The encoded data uses the @samp{0123456789ABCDEF} characters. The format
2367 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648#section-8, RFC 4648#8}.
2370 @opindex --base2lsbf
2371 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) binary string form
2372 (@samp{0} and @samp{1}) with the @emph{least} significant bit of every byte
2376 @opindex --base2msbf
2377 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) binary string form
2378 (@samp{0} and @samp{1}) with the @emph{most} significant bit of every byte
2383 Encode into (or decode from with @option{-d/--decode}) Z85 form
2384 (a modified Ascii85 form). The encoded data uses the
2385 @samp{0123456789abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTU@
2386 VWXYZ.-:+=^!/*?&<>()[]@{@}@@%$#}.
2387 characters. The format conforms to
2388 @uref{https://rfc.zeromq.org/spec:32/Z85/, ZeroMQ spec:32/Z85}.
2390 When encoding with @option{--z85}, input length must be a multiple of 4;
2391 when decoding with @option{--z85}, input length must be a multiple of 5.
2397 Encoding/decoding examples:
2400 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base64
2403 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base64url
2406 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base32
2409 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base32hex
2412 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base16
2415 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base2lsbf
2416 011111111111001001000001
2418 $ printf '\376\117\202' | basenc --base2msbf
2419 111111100100111110000010
2421 $ printf '\376\117\202\000' | basenc --z85
2424 $ printf 01010100 | basenc --base2msbf --decode
2427 $ printf 01010100 | basenc --base2lsbf --decode
2433 @node Formatting file contents
2434 @chapter Formatting file contents
2436 @cindex formatting file contents
2438 These commands reformat the contents of files.
2441 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
2442 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
2443 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
2447 @node fmt invocation
2448 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
2451 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
2452 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
2453 @cindex text, reformatting
2455 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
2456 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
2459 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2462 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
2463 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
2465 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
2466 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
2467 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
2470 @cindex line-breaking
2471 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
2472 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
2473 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
2474 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
2475 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
2476 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
2477 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
2478 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
2479 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
2480 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
2481 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
2482 @cite{Software: Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
2485 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2490 @itemx --crown-margin
2492 @opindex --crown-margin
2493 @cindex crown margin
2494 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
2495 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
2496 line with that of the second line.
2499 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
2501 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
2502 @cindex tagged paragraphs
2503 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
2504 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
2505 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
2511 @opindex --split-only
2512 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
2513 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
2514 being unduly combined.
2517 @itemx --uniform-spacing
2519 @opindex --uniform-spacing
2520 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
2521 between sentences to two spaces.
2524 @itemx -w @var{width}
2525 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2526 @opindex -@var{width}
2529 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75 or @var{goal}
2530 plus 10, if @var{goal} is provided).
2533 @itemx --goal=@var{goal}
2536 @command{fmt} initially tries to make lines @var{goal} characters wide.
2537 By default, this is 7% shorter than @var{width}.
2539 @item -p @var{prefix}
2540 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2541 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2542 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2543 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2544 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2545 leaving the code unchanged.
2552 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2555 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2556 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2557 @cindex merging files in parallel
2559 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2560 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2561 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2562 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2565 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2569 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2570 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2571 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2572 The default @var{page_length} is 66
2573 lines. The default number of text lines is therefore 56.
2574 The text line of the header takes the form
2575 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2576 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2577 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2578 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2579 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2580 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2581 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2584 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2585 feeds produce empty pages.
2587 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2588 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2589 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2591 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2592 truncate lines in that case.
2594 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2598 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2599 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2600 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain ':'
2601 @c The 'info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2602 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2603 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2604 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2605 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2606 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2607 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2608 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2609 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2610 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2611 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2612 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2616 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2617 @opindex -@var{column}
2619 @cindex down columns
2620 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2621 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2622 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2623 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2624 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2625 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2626 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2627 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2628 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2629 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2630 with @option{-m} option.
2636 @cindex across columns
2637 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2638 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2639 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2642 @itemx --show-control-chars
2644 @opindex --show-control-chars
2645 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2646 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2647 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2650 @itemx --double-space
2652 @opindex --double-space
2653 @cindex double spacing
2654 Double space the output.
2656 @item -D @var{format}
2657 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2658 @cindex time formats
2659 @cindex formatting times
2660 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2661 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}. @xref{date invocation}.
2662 Except for directives, which start with
2663 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2664 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2665 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2667 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2669 The default date format is @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example,
2670 @samp{2020-07-09 23:59});
2671 but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2672 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the POSIX
2673 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2674 @samp{Jul@ @ 9 23:59 2020}.
2677 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2678 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2679 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2680 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
2682 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2683 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2685 @opindex --expand-tabs
2687 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2688 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2689 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2697 @opindex --form-feed
2698 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. This does
2699 not alter the default page length of 66 lines.
2701 @item -h @var{header}
2702 @itemx --header=@var{header}
2705 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2706 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2707 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2709 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2710 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2712 @opindex --output-tabs
2714 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2715 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2716 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2722 @opindex --join-lines
2723 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2724 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2725 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2726 no column alignment used; may be used with
2727 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2728 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2729 to disentangle the old (POSIX-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2730 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2733 @item -l @var{page_length}
2734 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2737 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2738 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2739 than or equal to 10, the header and footer are omitted, as if the
2740 @option{-t} option had been given.
2746 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2747 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2748 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2750 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2751 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2752 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2753 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2754 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2755 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2756 the middle blank part.
2758 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2759 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2761 @opindex --number-lines
2762 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2763 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2764 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2765 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2766 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2767 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2768 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2769 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2770 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2771 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2772 printed with single column output only. The TAB width varies
2773 with the TAB position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2774 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2775 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a POSIX specification).
2776 The TAB width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2777 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2778 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2779 @var{number-separator} TAB@. The tabification depends upon the output
2782 @item -N @var{line_number}
2783 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2785 @opindex --first-line-number
2786 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2787 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2789 @item -o @var{margin}
2790 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2793 @cindex indenting lines
2795 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2796 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2797 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2798 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2801 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2803 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2804 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2805 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2807 @item -s[@var{char}]
2808 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2810 @opindex --separator
2811 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2812 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2813 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2814 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2815 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2816 @option{-w} is set. This is a POSIX-compliant formulation.
2819 @item -S[@var{string}]
2820 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2822 @opindex --sep-string
2823 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2824 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2825 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2826 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2828 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2829 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}).
2830 If no @samp{@var{string}} argument is specified, @samp{""} is assumed.
2833 @itemx --omit-header
2835 @opindex --omit-header
2836 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2837 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2838 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2839 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2840 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2841 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2842 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2845 @itemx --omit-pagination
2847 @opindex --omit-pagination
2848 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2849 set in the input files.
2852 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2854 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2855 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2857 @item -w @var{page_width}
2858 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2861 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2862 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). The specified
2863 @var{page_width} is rounded down so that columns have equal width.
2864 @option{-s[CHAR]} turns off the default page width and any line truncation
2865 and column alignment.
2866 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2867 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2868 A POSIX-compliant formulation.
2870 @item -W @var{page_width}
2871 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2873 @opindex --page_width
2874 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters, honored with and
2875 without a column option. With a column option, the specified @var{page_width}
2876 is rounded down so that columns have equal width. Text lines are truncated,
2877 unless @option{-J} is used. Together with one of the three column options
2878 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2879 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2880 don't disable the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2881 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2882 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2883 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}@. The header
2884 line is never truncated.
2891 @node fold invocation
2892 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2895 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2896 @cindex folding long input lines
2898 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2899 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2903 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2906 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2907 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2909 @cindex screen columns
2910 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2911 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2912 return sets the column to zero.
2914 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2922 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2923 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2930 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2931 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2932 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2934 @item -w @var{width}
2935 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2938 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2940 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2941 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2949 @node Output of parts of files
2950 @chapter Output of parts of files
2952 @cindex output of parts of files
2953 @cindex parts of files, output of
2955 These commands output pieces of the input.
2958 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2959 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2960 * split invocation:: Split a file into pieces.
2961 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2964 @node head invocation
2965 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2968 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2969 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2971 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2972 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2973 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2976 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2979 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2980 one-line header consisting of:
2983 ==> @var{file name} <==
2987 before the output for each @var{file}.
2989 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2993 @item -c [-]@var{num}
2994 @itemx --bytes=[-]@var{num}
2997 Print the first @var{num} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2998 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
2999 print all but the last @var{num} bytes of each file.
3000 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
3002 @item -n [-]@var{num}
3003 @itemx --lines=[-]@var{num}
3006 Output the first @var{num} lines.
3007 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{-},
3008 print all but the last @var{num} lines of each file.
3009 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3017 Never print file name headers.
3023 Always print file name headers.
3029 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
3030 @option{-[@var{num}][bkm][cqv]}, which is recognized only if it is
3031 specified first. @var{num} is a decimal number optionally followed
3032 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
3033 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
3034 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{num}}
3035 or @option{-n @var{num}} instead. If your script must also run on
3036 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
3037 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
3043 @node tail invocation
3044 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
3047 @cindex last part of files, outputting
3049 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
3050 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
3051 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3054 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3057 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
3058 one-line header before the output for each @var{file}, consisting of:
3061 ==> @var{file name} <==
3064 For further processing of tail output, it can be useful to convert the
3065 file headers to line prefixes, which can be done like:
3070 /^==> .* <==$/ @{prefix=substr($0,5,length-8)":"; next@}
3075 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
3076 GNU @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
3077 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
3078 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
3079 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
3080 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
3081 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
3082 the GNU @command{tac} command.
3084 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3088 @item -c [+]@var{num}
3089 @itemx --bytes=[+]@var{num}
3092 Output the last @var{num} bytes, instead of final lines.
3093 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
3094 byte @var{num} from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
3095 @multiplierSuffixes{num}
3098 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
3101 @cindex growing files
3102 @vindex name @r{follow option}
3103 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
3104 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
3105 presumably because the file is growing.
3106 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
3107 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
3110 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
3111 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
3113 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
3114 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
3115 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
3116 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
3117 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file, perhaps by reopening it
3118 periodically to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
3119 Note that the inotify-based implementation handles this case without
3120 the need for any periodic reopening.
3122 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
3123 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
3124 and resumes tracking from the start of the file, assuming it has been
3125 truncated to 0, which is the usual truncation operation for log files.
3127 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
3128 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
3129 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
3130 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
3131 periodically to see if the file reappears.
3132 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
3133 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
3134 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
3137 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
3138 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
3140 The @option{-f} option is ignored if
3141 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
3142 Likewise, the @option{-f} option has no effect for any
3143 operand specified as @samp{-}, when standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
3145 With kernel inotify support, output is triggered by file changes
3146 and is generally very prompt.
3147 Otherwise, @command{tail} sleeps for one second between checks --
3148 use @option{--sleep-interval=@var{n}} to change that default -- which can
3149 make the output appear slightly less responsive or bursty.
3150 When using tail without inotify support, you can make it more responsive
3151 by using a sub-second sleep interval, e.g., via an alias like this:
3154 alias tail='tail -s.1'
3159 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
3160 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
3161 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
3163 @item --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
3164 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
3165 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
3166 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
3167 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
3168 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
3169 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
3170 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
3171 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
3172 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
3173 This option is meaningful only when polling (i.e., without inotify)
3174 and when following by name.
3176 @item -n [+]@var{num}
3177 @itemx --lines=[+]@var{}
3180 Output the last @var{num} lines.
3181 However, if @var{num} is prefixed with a @samp{+}, start printing with
3182 line @var{num} from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
3183 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
3185 @item --pid=@var{pid}
3187 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
3188 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
3189 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
3190 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
3191 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
3192 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
3193 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
3194 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
3198 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
3201 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
3202 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
3203 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
3204 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
3205 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
3206 will print a warning if this is the case.
3214 Never print file name headers.
3218 Indefinitely try to open the specified file.
3219 This option is useful mainly when following (and otherwise issues a warning).
3221 When following by file descriptor (i.e., with @option{--follow=descriptor}),
3222 this option only affects the initial open of the file, as after a successful
3223 open, @command{tail} will start following the file descriptor.
3225 When following by name (i.e., with @option{--follow=name}), @command{tail}
3226 infinitely retries to re-open the given files until killed.
3228 Without this option, when @command{tail} encounters a file that doesn't
3229 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
3230 never checks it again.
3232 @item -s @var{number}
3233 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
3235 @opindex --sleep-interval
3236 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
3237 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
3239 When @command{tail} uses inotify, this polling-related option
3240 is usually ignored. However, if you also specify @option{--pid=@var{p}},
3241 @command{tail} checks whether process @var{p} is alive at least
3242 every @var{number} seconds.
3243 The @var{number} must be non-negative and can be a floating-point number
3244 in either the current or the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
3250 Always print file name headers.
3256 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
3257 @samp{tail -[@var{num}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
3258 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
3259 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
3260 file. In the option, @var{num} is an optional decimal number optionally
3261 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
3262 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
3263 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
3265 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3266 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001, the leading @samp{-}
3267 can be replaced by @samp{+} in the traditional option syntax with the
3268 same meaning as in counts, and on obsolete systems predating POSIX
3269 1003.1-2001 traditional usage overrides normal usage when the two
3270 conflict. This behavior can be controlled with the
3271 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3274 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
3275 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{num}[b]}, @option{-n
3276 @var{num}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
3277 run on hosts that support only the traditional syntax, you can often
3278 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
3279 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
3280 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
3281 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
3283 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
3284 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the POSIX
3285 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
3286 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
3287 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
3288 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
3289 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
3294 @node split invocation
3295 @section @command{split}: Split a file into pieces.
3298 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
3299 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
3301 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive or interleaved
3302 sections of @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input}
3303 is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3306 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
3309 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
3310 left over for the last section), into each output file.
3312 @cindex output file name prefix
3313 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
3314 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
3315 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
3316 sorted order by file name produces the original input file (except
3317 @option{-nr/@var{n}}). By default split will initially create files
3318 with two generated suffix characters, and will increase this width by two
3319 when the next most significant position reaches the last character.
3320 (@samp{yz}, @samp{zaaa}, @samp{zaab}, @dots{}). In this way an arbitrary
3321 number of output files are supported, which sort as described above,
3322 even in the presence of an @option{--additional-suffix} option.
3323 If the @option{-a} option is specified and the output file names are
3324 exhausted, @command{split} reports an error without deleting the
3325 output files that it did create.
3327 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3331 @item -l @var{lines}
3332 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
3335 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
3336 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3337 the number of records.
3339 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
3340 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use
3341 @option{-l @var{lines}} instead.
3344 @itemx --bytes=@var{size}
3347 Put @var{size} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
3348 @multiplierSuffixes{size}
3351 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{size}
3353 @opindex --line-bytes
3354 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
3355 possible without exceeding @var{size} bytes. Individual lines or records
3356 longer than @var{size} bytes are broken into multiple files.
3357 @var{size} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes} option.
3358 If @option{--separator} is specified, then @var{lines} determines
3359 the number of records.
3361 @item --filter=@var{command}
3363 With this option, rather than simply writing to each output file,
3364 write through a pipe to the specified shell @var{command} for each output file.
3365 @var{command} should use the $FILE environment variable, which is set
3366 to a different output file name for each invocation of the command.
3367 For example, imagine that you have a 1TiB compressed file
3368 that, if uncompressed, would be too large to reside on secondary storage,
3369 yet you must split it into individually-compressed pieces
3370 of a more manageable size.
3371 To do that, you might run this command:
3374 xz -dc BIG.xz | split -b200G --filter='xz > $FILE.xz' - big-
3377 Assuming a 10:1 compression ratio, that would create about fifty 20GiB files
3378 with names @file{big-aa.xz}, @file{big-ab.xz}, @file{big-ac.xz}, etc.
3380 @item -n @var{chunks}
3381 @itemx --number=@var{chunks}
3385 Split @var{input} to @var{chunks} output files where @var{chunks} may be:
3388 @var{n} generate @var{n} files based on current size of @var{input}
3389 @var{k}/@var{n} output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to standard output
3390 l/@var{n} generate @var{n} files without splitting lines or records
3391 l/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3392 r/@var{n} like @samp{l} but use round robin distribution
3393 r/@var{k}/@var{n} likewise but output only @var{k}th of @var{n} to stdout
3396 If the input size is not a multiple of @var{n}, early output files are
3397 one byte longer than later output files, to make up the difference.
3398 Any excess bytes appearing after the initial calculation are discarded
3399 (except when using @samp{r} mode).
3401 All @var{n} files are created even if there are fewer than @var{n} lines,
3402 or the @var{input} is truncated.
3404 For @samp{l} mode, chunks are approximately @var{input} size / @var{n}.
3405 Although the @var{input} is still partitioned as before into @var{n} regions
3406 of approximately equal size, if a line @emph{starts} within a partition
3407 it is written completely to the corresponding file. Since lines or records
3408 are not split even if they overlap a partition, the files written
3409 can be larger or smaller than the partition size, and even empty
3410 if a line/record is so long as to completely overlap the partition.
3412 When the input is a pipe or some other special file where the size
3413 cannot easily be determined, there is no trouble for @samp{r} mode
3414 because the size of the input is irrelevant. For other modes, such an
3415 input is first copied to a temporary to determine its size.
3417 @item -a @var{length}
3418 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
3420 @opindex --suffix-length
3421 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. If a @var{length} of 0 is specified,
3422 this is the same as if (any previous) @option{-a} was not specified, and
3423 thus enables the default behavior, which starts the suffix length at 2,
3424 and unless @option{-n} or @option{--numeric-suffixes=@var{from}} is
3425 specified, will auto increase the length by 2 as required.
3428 @itemx --numeric-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3430 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
3431 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters. The numerical
3432 suffix counts from @var{from} if specified, 0 otherwise.
3434 @var{from} is supported with the long form option, and is used to either set the
3435 initial suffix for a single run, or to set the suffix offset for independently
3436 split inputs, and consequently the auto suffix length expansion described above
3437 is disabled. Therefore you may also want to use option @option{-a} to allow
3438 suffixes beyond @samp{99}. Note if option @option{--number} is specified and
3439 the number of files is less than @var{from}, a single run is assumed and the
3440 minimum suffix length required is automatically determined.
3443 @itemx --hex-suffixes[=@var{from}]
3445 @opindex --hex-suffixes
3446 Like @option{--numeric-suffixes}, but use hexadecimal numbers (in lower case).
3448 @item --additional-suffix=@var{suffix}
3449 @opindex --additional-suffix
3450 Append an additional @var{suffix} to output file names. @var{suffix}
3451 must not contain slash.
3454 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3456 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3457 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. This can happen
3458 with the @option{--number} option if a file is (truncated to be) shorter
3459 than the number requested, or if a line is so long as to completely
3460 span a chunk. The output file sequence numbers, always run consecutively
3461 even when this option is specified.
3463 @item -t @var{separator}
3464 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
3466 @opindex --separator
3467 @cindex line separator character
3468 @cindex record separator character
3469 Use character @var{separator} as the record separator instead of the default
3470 newline character (ASCII LF).
3471 To specify ASCII NUL as the separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0},
3472 e.g., @samp{split -t '\0'}.
3477 @opindex --unbuffered
3478 Immediately copy input to output in @option{--number r/@dots{}} mode,
3479 which is a much slower mode of operation.
3483 Write a diagnostic just before each output file is opened.
3489 Here are a few examples to illustrate how the
3490 @option{--number} (@option{-n}) option works:
3492 Notice how, by default, one line may be split onto two or more:
3495 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -n3 k; head xa?
3508 Use the "l/" modifier to suppress that:
3511 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nl/3 k; head xa?
3524 Use the "r/" modifier to distribute lines in a round-robin fashion:
3527 $ seq -w 6 10 > k; split -nr/3 k; head xa?
3540 You can also extract just the Kth chunk.
3541 This extracts and prints just the 7th "chunk" of 33:
3544 $ seq 100 > k; split -nl/7/33 k
3551 @node csplit invocation
3552 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
3555 @cindex context splitting
3556 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
3558 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
3559 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
3562 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
3565 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
3566 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
3567 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
3568 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
3569 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
3572 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
3573 output file after it has been created.
3575 The types of pattern arguments are:
3580 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
3581 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
3582 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
3583 file once for each repeat.
3585 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
3586 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
3587 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
3588 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer, that can
3589 be preceded by @samp{+} or @samp{-}.
3590 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
3591 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
3592 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
3593 Note lines within a negative offset of a regexp pattern
3594 are not matched in subsequent regexp patterns.
3596 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
3597 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
3598 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
3600 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
3601 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
3602 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
3603 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
3608 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
3609 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
3610 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
3611 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
3612 original input file, excluding portions skipped with a %@var{regexp}%
3613 pattern or the @option{--suppress-matched} option.
3615 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
3616 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
3617 that it has created so far before it exits.
3619 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3623 @item -f @var{prefix}
3624 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
3627 @cindex output file name prefix
3628 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
3630 @item -b @var{format}
3631 @itemx --suffix-format=@var{format}
3633 @opindex --suffix-format
3634 @cindex output file name suffix
3635 Use @var{format} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
3636 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
3637 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
3638 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specification,
3639 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
3640 binary unsigned integer argument to readable form. The format letters
3641 @samp{d} and @samp{i} are aliases for @samp{u}, and the
3642 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
3643 entire @var{format} is given (with the current output file number) to
3644 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
3645 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
3646 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
3648 @item -n @var{digits}
3649 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
3652 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
3653 long instead of the default 2.
3658 @opindex --keep-files
3659 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
3661 @item --suppress-matched
3662 @opindex --suppress-matched
3663 Do not output lines matching the specified @var{pattern}.
3664 I.e., suppress the boundary line from the start of the second
3665 and subsequent splits.
3668 @itemx --elide-empty-files
3670 @opindex --elide-empty-files
3671 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
3672 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
3673 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
3674 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
3675 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
3686 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
3692 Here is an example of its usage.
3693 First, create an empty directory for the exercise,
3700 Now, split the sequence of 1..14 on lines that end with 0 or 5:
3703 $ seq 14 | csplit - '/[05]$/' '@{*@}'
3709 Each number printed above is the size of an output
3710 file that csplit has just created.
3711 List the names of those output files:
3718 Use @command{head} to show their contents:
3743 Example of splitting input by empty lines:
3746 $ csplit --suppress-matched @var{input.txt} '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3750 @c TODO: "uniq" already supports "--group".
3751 @c when it gets the "--key" option, uncomment this example.
3753 @c Example of splitting input file, based on the value of column 2:
3756 @c $ cat @var{input.txt} |
3758 @c uniq --group -k2,2 |
3759 @c csplit -m '/^$/' '@{*@}'
3762 @node Summarizing files
3763 @chapter Summarizing files
3765 @cindex summarizing files
3767 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
3771 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
3772 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
3773 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
3774 * b2sum invocation:: Print or check BLAKE2 digests.
3775 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
3776 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
3777 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
3782 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3786 @cindex character count
3790 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, words, and newlines
3791 in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given
3792 or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. A word is a nonzero length
3793 sequence of printable characters delimited by white space. Synopsis:
3796 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3799 @cindex total counts
3800 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3801 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. By default
3802 if more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3803 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}.
3804 This @samp{total} line can be controlled with the @option{--total} option,
3805 which is a GNU extension.
3806 The counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3807 maximum line length.
3808 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3809 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3810 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3811 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3812 However, as a GNU extension, if only one count is printed,
3813 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3815 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3816 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3817 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3824 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3826 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3827 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3828 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths. The line lengths here
3829 are measured in screen columns, according to the current locale and
3830 assuming tab positions in every 8th column.
3832 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3840 Print only the byte counts.
3846 Print only the character counts, as per the current locale.
3847 Invalid characters are not counted.
3853 Print only the word counts. A word is a nonzero length
3854 sequence of printable characters separated by white space.
3860 Print only the newline character counts.
3861 Note a file without a trailing newline character,
3862 will not have that last portion included in the line count.
3865 @itemx --max-line-length
3867 @opindex --max-line-length
3868 Print only the maximum display widths.
3869 Tabs are set at every 8th column.
3870 Display widths of wide characters are considered.
3871 Non-printable characters are given 0 width.
3873 @item --total=@var{when}
3874 @opindex --total=@var{when}
3875 Control when and how the final line with cumulative counts is printed.
3876 @var{when} is one of:
3879 @vindex auto @r{total option}
3880 - This is the default mode of @command{wc} when no @option{--total}
3881 option is specified. Output a total line if more than one @var{file}
3884 @vindex always @r{total option}
3885 - Always output a total line, irrespective of the number of files processed.
3887 @vindex only @r{total option}
3888 - Only output total counts. I.e., don't print individual file counts,
3889 suppress any leading spaces, and don't print the @samp{total} word itself,
3890 to simplify subsequent processing.
3892 @vindex none @r{total option}
3893 - Never output a total line.
3896 @macro filesZeroFromOption{cmd,withTotalOption,subListOutput}
3897 @item --files0-from=@var{file}
3898 @opindex --files0-from=@var{file}
3899 @c This is commented out to avoid a texi2dvi failure.
3900 @c texi2dvi (GNU Texinfo 4.11) 1.104
3901 @c @cindex including files from @command{\cmd\}
3902 Disallow processing files named on the command line, and instead process
3903 those named in file @var{file}; each name being terminated by a zero byte
3905 This is useful \withTotalOption\
3906 when the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3908 In such cases, running @command{\cmd\} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3909 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{\cmd\} print
3910 \subListOutput\ for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3911 One way to produce a list of ASCII NUL terminated file
3913 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
3914 If @var{file} is @samp{-} then the ASCII NUL terminated
3915 file names are read from standard input.
3917 @filesZeroFromOption{wc,,a total}
3919 For example, to find the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or
3920 @file{.h} file in the current hierarchy, do this:
3923 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 |
3924 wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3932 @node sum invocation
3933 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3936 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3937 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3939 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3940 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3943 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3946 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3947 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If at least one @var{file}
3948 is given, file names are also printed.
3950 By default, GNU @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3951 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3954 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3960 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3961 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3962 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3963 given, it has no effect.
3969 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3970 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3971 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3975 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3976 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3981 @node cksum invocation
3982 @section @command{cksum}: Print and verify file checksums
3985 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3986 @cindex CRC checksum
3987 @cindex 32-bit checksum
3988 @cindex checksum, 32-bit
3991 @command{cksum} by default computes a 32-bit cyclic redundancy check (CRC)
3992 checksum for each given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for
3993 a @var{file} of @samp{-}.
3995 cksum also supports the @option{-a/--algorithm} option to select the
3996 digest algorithm to use. @command{cksum} is the preferred interface
3997 to these digests, subsuming the other standalone checksumming utilities,
3998 which can be emulated using @code{cksum -a md5 --untagged "$@@"} etc.
4002 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4005 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files have not been corrupted,
4006 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
4007 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
4010 @command{cksum} by default prints the POSIX standard CRC checksum
4011 for each file along with the number of bytes in the file,
4012 and the file name unless no arguments were given.
4013 The 32-bit CRC used is based on the polynomial used
4014 for CRC error checking in the ISO/IEC 8802-3:1996 standard (Ethernet).
4016 The same usage and options as the @command{b2sum}
4017 command are supported. @xref{b2sum invocation}.
4018 In addition @command{cksum} supports the following options.
4025 @opindex --algorithm
4026 @cindex digest algorithm
4027 Compute checksums using the specified digest algorithm.
4029 Supported legacy checksums (which are not supported by @option{--check}):
4031 @samp{sysv} equivalent to @command{sum -s}
4032 @samp{bsd} equivalent to @command{sum -r}
4033 @samp{crc} equivalent to @command{cksum} (the default)
4036 Supported more modern digest algorithms are:
4038 @samp{md5} equivalent to @command{md5sum}
4039 @samp{sha1} equivalent to @command{sha1sum}
4040 @samp{sha224} equivalent to @command{sha224sum}
4041 @samp{sha256} equivalent to @command{sha256sum}
4042 @samp{sha384} equivalent to @command{sha384sum}
4043 @samp{sha512} equivalent to @command{sha512sum}
4044 @samp{blake2b} equivalent to @command{b2sum}
4045 @samp{sm3} only available through @command{cksum}
4052 @cindex base64 checksum encoding
4053 Print base64-encoded digests not hexadecimal.
4054 This option is ignored with @option{--check}.
4055 The format conforms to
4056 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc4648#section-4, RFC 4648#4}.
4058 Note that each base64-encoded digest has zero, one or two trailing padding
4059 (@samp{=}) bytes. The length of that padding is the checksum-bit-length
4060 modulo 3, and the @option{--check} parser requires precisely the same
4061 input digest string as what is output. I.e., removing or adding any
4062 @samp{=} padding renders a digest non-matching.
4066 Output extra information to stderr, like the checksum implementation being used.
4070 @cindex raw binary checksum
4071 Print only the unencoded raw binary digest for a single input.
4072 Do not output the file name or anything else.
4073 Use network byte order (big endian) where applicable:
4074 for @samp{bsd}, @samp{crc}, and @samp{sysv}.
4075 This option works only with a single input.
4076 Unlike other output formats, @command{cksum} provides no way to
4077 @option{--check} a @option{--raw} checksum.
4081 Output using the original Coreutils format used by the other
4082 standalone checksum utilities like @command{md5sum} for example.
4083 This format has the checksum at the start of the line, and may be
4084 more amenable to further processing by other utilities,
4085 especially in combination with the @option{--zero} option.
4086 Note this does not identify the digest algorithm used for the checksum.
4087 @xref{md5sum invocation} for details of this format.
4091 @node b2sum invocation
4092 @section @command{b2sum}: Print or check BLAKE2 digests
4096 @cindex 512-bit checksum
4097 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4098 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4099 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4101 @command{b2sum} computes a 512-bit checksum for each specified
4102 @var{file}. The same usage and options as the @command{md5sum}
4103 command are supported. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
4104 In addition @command{b2sum} supports the following options.
4111 @cindex BLAKE2 hash length
4112 Change (shorten) the default digest length.
4113 This is specified in bits and thus must be a multiple of 8.
4114 This option is ignored when @option{--check} is specified,
4115 as the length is automatically determined when checking.
4118 @node md5sum invocation
4119 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
4123 @cindex 128-bit checksum
4124 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
4125 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
4126 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
4128 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
4129 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
4131 @macro weakHash{hash}
4132 Note: The \hash\ digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
4133 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
4134 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical \hash\
4135 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered secure
4136 against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a given \hash\
4137 fingerprint is considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how
4138 to modify certain files, including digital certificates, so that they
4139 appear valid when signed with an \hash\ digest. For more secure hashes,
4140 consider using SHA-2, or the newer @command{b2sum} command.
4141 @xref{sha2 utilities}. @xref{b2sum invocation}.
4145 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
4146 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
4147 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
4148 consistent. Synopsis:
4151 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4154 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs by default, the MD5 checksum,
4155 a space, a flag indicating binary or text input mode, and the file name.
4156 Binary mode is indicated with @samp{*}, text mode with @samp{ } (space).
4157 Binary mode is the default on systems where it's significant,
4158 otherwise text mode is the default. The @command{cksum} command always
4159 uses binary mode and a @samp{ } (space) flag.
4161 Without @option{--zero}, if @var{file} contains a backslash, newline,
4162 or carriage return, the line is started with a backslash, and each
4163 problematic character in the file name is escaped with a backslash,
4164 making the output unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
4166 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
4168 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4176 @cindex binary input files
4177 Note this option is not supported by the @command{cksum} command,
4178 as it operates in binary mode exclusively.
4179 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
4180 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
4181 On systems like GNU that do not distinguish between binary
4182 and text files, this option merely flags each input mode as binary:
4183 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
4184 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
4185 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
4189 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
4190 @var{file} (or from standard input if no @var{file} was specified) and report
4191 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
4192 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
4193 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
4195 Three input formats are supported. Either the default output
4196 format described above, the @option{--tag} output format,
4197 or the BSD reversed mode format which is similar to the default mode,
4198 but doesn't use a character to distinguish binary and text modes.
4200 For the @command{cksum} command, the @option{--check} option
4201 supports auto-detecting the digest algorithm to use,
4202 when presented with checksum information in the @option{--tag} output format.
4204 Also for the @command{cksum} command, the @option{--check} option
4205 auto-detects the digest encoding, accepting both standard hexidecimal
4206 checksums and those generated via @command{cksum} with its
4207 @option{--base64} option.
4209 Output with @option{--zero} enabled is not supported by @option{--check}.
4211 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
4212 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
4213 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
4214 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
4215 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
4216 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
4217 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
4218 a warning is issued to standard error.
4219 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
4220 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
4221 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
4222 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
4223 it exits successfully.
4224 Note the @command{cksum} command doesn't support @option{--check}
4225 with the older @samp{sysv}, @samp{bsd}, or @samp{crc} algorithms.
4227 @item --ignore-missing
4228 @opindex --ignore-missing
4229 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
4230 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4231 When verifying checksums, don't fail or report any status
4232 for missing files. This is useful when verifying a subset
4233 of downloaded files given a larger list of checksums.
4237 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
4238 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4239 When verifying checksums, don't generate an 'OK' message per successfully
4240 checked file. Files that fail the verification are reported in the
4241 default one-line-per-file format. If there is any checksum mismatch,
4242 print a warning summarizing the failures to standard error.
4246 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
4247 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
4248 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
4249 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
4250 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
4252 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
4253 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
4254 indicating there was a failure.
4259 Output BSD style checksums, which indicate the checksum algorithm used.
4260 As a GNU extension, if @option{--zero} is not used, file names with problematic
4261 characters are escaped as described above, with the same escaping indicator of
4262 @samp{\} at the start of the line, being used.
4263 The @option{--tag} option implies binary mode, and is disallowed with
4264 @option{--text} mode as supporting that would unnecessarily complicate
4265 the output format, while providing little benefit.
4266 The @command{cksum} command, uses @option{--tag} as its default output format.
4272 @cindex text input files
4273 Note this option is not supported by the @command{cksum} command.
4274 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
4275 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
4276 This option is the default on systems like GNU that do not
4277 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
4278 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
4279 terminal. This mode is never defaulted to if @option{--tag} is used.
4285 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
4286 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
4287 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
4292 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
4293 When verifying checksums,
4294 if one or more input line is invalid,
4295 exit nonzero after all warnings have been issued.
4298 Also file name escaping is not used.
4304 @node sha1sum invocation
4305 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
4309 @cindex 160-bit checksum
4310 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
4311 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
4312 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
4314 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
4315 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
4316 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
4321 @node sha2 utilities
4322 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
4329 @cindex 224-bit checksum
4330 @cindex 256-bit checksum
4331 @cindex 384-bit checksum
4332 @cindex 512-bit checksum
4333 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
4334 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
4335 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
4336 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
4337 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
4338 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
4339 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
4340 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
4341 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
4342 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
4343 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
4344 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
4346 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
4347 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
4348 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
4349 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
4350 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}
4351 and @command{sha1sum}.
4352 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
4355 @node Operating on sorted files
4356 @chapter Operating on sorted files
4358 @cindex operating on sorted files
4359 @cindex sorted files, operations on
4361 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
4364 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
4365 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
4366 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
4367 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
4368 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
4369 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
4373 @node sort invocation
4374 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
4377 @cindex sorting files
4379 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
4380 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
4381 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
4385 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4388 @cindex sort stability
4389 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4390 Many options affect how @command{sort} compares lines; if the results
4391 are unexpected, try the @option{--debug} option to see what happened.
4392 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
4393 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields (see @option{--key}), in the
4394 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
4395 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
4396 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
4397 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
4398 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
4399 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
4400 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
4401 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
4402 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
4403 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
4407 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
4408 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
4409 use a non-POSIX locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
4410 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
4411 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
4412 environment variable to @samp{C}@. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
4413 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
4414 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
4415 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
4416 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
4417 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
4418 A line's trailing newline is not part of the line for comparison
4419 purposes. If the final byte of an input file is not a newline, GNU
4420 @command{sort} silently supplies one. GNU @command{sort} (as
4421 specified for all GNU utilities) has no limit on input line length or
4422 restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
4424 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
4425 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
4432 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
4435 @cindex checking for sortedness
4436 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
4437 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
4438 exit with a status of 1.
4439 Otherwise, exit successfully.
4440 At most one input file can be given.
4443 @itemx --check=quiet
4444 @itemx --check=silent
4447 @cindex checking for sortedness
4448 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
4449 exit with status 1 otherwise.
4450 At most one input file can be given.
4451 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
4457 @cindex merging sorted files
4458 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
4459 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
4460 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
4465 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
4469 0 if no error occurred
4470 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
4471 2 if an error occurred
4475 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
4476 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
4477 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
4478 the environment variable.
4480 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
4481 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
4482 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
4483 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
4484 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-POSIX
4485 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
4486 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
4491 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
4493 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
4494 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
4496 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
4497 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4498 can change this. Note blanks may be ignored by your locale's collating
4499 rules, but without this option they will be significant for character
4500 positions specified in keys with the @option{-k} option.
4503 @itemx --dictionary-order
4505 @opindex --dictionary-order
4506 @cindex dictionary order
4507 @cindex phone directory order
4508 @cindex telephone directory order
4510 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
4511 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
4512 By default letters and digits are those of ASCII and a blank
4513 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
4516 @itemx --ignore-case
4518 @opindex --ignore-case
4519 @cindex ignoring case
4520 @cindex case folding
4522 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
4523 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
4524 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4525 When used with @option{--unique} those lower case equivalent lines are
4526 thrown away. (There is currently no way to throw away the upper case
4527 equivalent instead. (Any @option{--reverse} given would only affect
4528 the final result, after the throwing away.))
4531 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
4532 @itemx --sort=general-numeric
4534 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
4536 @cindex general numeric sort
4538 Sort numerically, converting a prefix of each line to a long
4539 double-precision floating point number. @xref{Floating point}.
4540 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
4541 Use the following collating sequence:
4545 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
4547 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
4548 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
4552 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
4557 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
4558 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
4559 converting to floating point.
4561 You can use this option to sort hexadecimal numbers prefixed with
4562 @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, where those numbers are not fixed width,
4563 or of varying case. However for hex numbers of consistent case,
4564 and left padded with @samp{0} to a consistent width, a standard
4565 lexicographic sort will be faster.
4568 @itemx --human-numeric-sort
4569 @itemx --sort=human-numeric
4571 @opindex --human-numeric-sort
4573 @cindex human numeric sort
4575 Sort numerically, first by numeric sign (negative, zero, or positive);
4576 then by SI suffix (either empty, or @samp{k} or @samp{K}, or
4577 one of @samp{MGTPEZYRQ}, in that order; @pxref{Block size}); and finally
4578 by numeric value. For example, @samp{1023M} sorts before @samp{1G}
4579 because @samp{M} (mega) precedes @samp{G} (giga) as an SI
4580 suffix. This option sorts values that are consistently scaled to the
4581 nearest suffix, regardless of whether suffixes denote powers of 1000
4582 or 1024, and it therefore sorts the output of any single invocation of
4583 the @command{df}, @command{du}, or @command{ls} commands that are
4584 invoked with their @option{--human-readable} or @option{--si} options.
4585 The syntax for numbers is the same as for the @option{--numeric-sort}
4586 option; the SI suffix must immediately follow the number.
4587 Note also the @command{numfmt} command, which can be used to reformat
4588 numbers to human format @emph{after} the sort, thus often allowing
4589 sort to operate on more accurate numbers.
4592 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
4594 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
4595 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
4596 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
4598 Ignore nonprinting characters.
4599 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
4600 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
4601 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
4607 @opindex --month-sort
4609 @cindex months, sorting by
4611 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
4612 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
4613 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}@.
4614 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
4615 category determines the month spellings.
4616 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4620 @itemx --numeric-sort
4621 @itemx --sort=numeric
4623 @opindex --numeric-sort
4625 @cindex numeric sort
4627 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
4628 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
4629 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
4630 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
4631 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
4632 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
4633 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4636 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
4638 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
4639 To compare such strings numerically, use the
4640 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
4643 @itemx --version-sort
4645 @opindex --version-sort
4646 @cindex version number sort
4647 Sort by version name and number. It behaves like a standard sort,
4648 except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
4649 as an index/version number. (@xref{Version sort ordering}.)
4655 @cindex reverse sorting
4656 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
4657 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
4660 @itemx --random-sort
4661 @itemx --sort=random
4663 @opindex --random-sort
4666 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
4667 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
4668 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
4669 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
4670 except that keys with the same value sort together.
4672 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
4673 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
4674 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
4677 The choice of hash function is affected by the
4678 @option{--random-source} option.
4686 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
4687 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
4689 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
4690 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
4691 standard input to standard output.
4693 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
4695 White space and the backslash character should not appear in
4696 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
4698 @filesZeroFromOption{sort,,sorted output}
4700 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4701 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
4705 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
4706 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
4707 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
4709 In its simplest form @var{pos} specifies a field number (starting with 1),
4710 with fields being separated by runs of blank characters, and by default
4711 those blanks being included in the comparison at the start of each field.
4712 To adjust the handling of blank characters see the @option{-b} and
4713 @option{-t} options.
4716 each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
4717 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
4718 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
4719 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
4720 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
4721 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
4722 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
4723 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
4724 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
4727 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
4728 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more notes on keys and more examples.
4729 See also the @option{--debug} option to help determine the part
4730 of the line being used in the sort.
4733 Highlight the portion of each line used for sorting.
4734 Also issue warnings about questionable usage to standard error.
4736 @item --batch-size=@var{nmerge}
4737 @opindex --batch-size
4738 @cindex number of inputs to merge, nmerge
4739 Merge at most @var{nmerge} inputs at once.
4741 When @command{sort} has to merge more than @var{nmerge} inputs,
4742 it merges them in groups of @var{nmerge}, saving the result in
4743 a temporary file, which is then used as an input in a subsequent merge.
4745 A large value of @var{nmerge} may improve merge performance and decrease
4746 temporary storage utilization at the expense of increased memory usage
4747 and I/O@. Conversely a small value of @var{nmerge} may reduce memory
4748 requirements and I/O at the expense of temporary storage consumption and
4751 The value of @var{nmerge} must be at least 2. The default value is
4752 currently 16, but this is implementation-dependent and may change in
4755 The value of @var{nmerge} may be bounded by a resource limit for open
4756 file descriptors. The commands @samp{ulimit -n} or @samp{getconf
4757 OPEN_MAX} may display limits for your systems; these limits may be
4758 modified further if your program already has some files open, or if
4759 the operating system has other limits on the number of open files. If
4760 the value of @var{nmerge} exceeds the resource limit, @command{sort}
4761 silently uses a smaller value.
4763 @item -o @var{output-file}
4764 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4767 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4768 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4769 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
4770 @var{output-file}, so you can sort a file in place by using
4771 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}@.
4772 However, it is often safer to output to an otherwise-unused file, as
4773 data may be lost if the system crashes or @command{sort} encounters
4774 an I/O or other serious error while a file is being sorted in place.
4775 Also, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
4776 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
4777 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
4778 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
4780 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4781 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
4782 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}@. Portable
4783 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
4786 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4787 @opindex --random-source
4788 @cindex random source for sorting
4789 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4790 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
4797 @cindex sort stability
4798 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
4800 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
4801 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
4802 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
4805 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
4807 @opindex --buffer-size
4808 @cindex size for main memory sorting
4809 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
4810 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
4811 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
4812 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
4813 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
4814 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, @samp{Y}, @samp{R}, and @samp{Q}@.
4816 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
4819 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
4820 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
4821 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
4822 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
4825 @item -t @var{separator}
4826 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
4828 @opindex --field-separator
4829 @cindex field separator character
4830 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
4831 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
4832 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
4833 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
4836 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
4837 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
4838 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
4839 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
4840 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
4841 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
4842 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
4843 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
4845 To specify ASCII NUL as the field separator,
4846 use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g., @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
4848 @item -T @var{tempdir}
4849 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
4851 @opindex --temporary-directory
4852 @cindex temporary directory
4854 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
4855 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
4856 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
4857 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
4858 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
4861 @item --parallel=@var{n}
4863 @cindex multithreaded sort
4864 Set the number of sorts run in parallel to @var{n}. By default,
4865 @var{n} is set to the number of available processors, but limited
4866 to 8, as there are diminishing performance gains after that.
4867 Note also that using @var{n} threads increases the memory usage by
4868 a factor of log @var{n}. Also see @ref{nproc invocation}.
4874 @cindex uniquifying output
4876 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
4877 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
4878 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
4880 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
4882 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
4883 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
4884 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
4885 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
4886 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
4889 @macro newlineFieldSeparator
4890 Note with @option{-z} the newline character is treated as a field separator.
4895 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
4896 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
4897 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}.
4898 GNU sort follows the POSIX
4899 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
4900 According to POSIX, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
4901 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
4902 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
4903 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
4905 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
4906 of the option letters @samp{MbdfghinRrV} appended to it, in which case no
4907 global ordering options are inherited by that particular field. The
4908 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
4909 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
4910 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
4911 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
4912 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b} or
4913 an option that implicitly ignores leading blanks (@samp{Mghn}) as otherwise
4914 the varying numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
4916 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
4917 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
4918 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
4919 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
4921 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4922 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
4923 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
4924 @command{sort} supports a traditional origin-zero
4925 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
4926 The traditional command @samp{sort +@var{a}.@var{x} -@var{b}.@var{y}}
4927 is equivalent to @samp{sort -k @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b}} if @var{y}
4928 is @samp{0} or absent, otherwise it is equivalent to @samp{sort -k
4929 @var{a+1}.@var{x+1},@var{b+1}.@var{y}}.
4931 This traditional behavior can be controlled with the
4932 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4933 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
4934 not set by using the traditional syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
4936 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid traditional
4937 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
4938 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
4939 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
4940 support only the traditional syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
4941 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
4944 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
4949 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
4956 Run no more than 4 sorts concurrently, using a buffer size of 10M.
4959 sort --parallel=4 -S 10M
4963 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
4964 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
4965 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
4966 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
4967 and extending to the end of each line.
4974 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
4975 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
4976 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
4979 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
4982 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
4983 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
4984 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
4985 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
4986 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
4988 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
4989 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
4990 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
4991 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
4992 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
4993 field-end part of the key specifier.
4996 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
4997 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
4998 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
5002 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
5003 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
5004 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
5007 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
5008 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
5009 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
5010 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
5011 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
5012 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
5013 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
5017 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
5018 timestamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
5019 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
5020 files contain lines that look like this:
5023 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2020:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
5024 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2020:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
5027 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
5028 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
5029 because 61 is less than 129.
5032 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
5033 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
5036 This example cannot be done with a single POSIX @command{sort} invocation,
5037 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
5038 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
5039 @command{sort}: the first sorts by timestamp and the second by IPv4
5040 address. The timestamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
5041 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
5042 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
5043 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
5044 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
5045 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
5046 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
5047 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
5048 sorts is stable. Note as a GNU extension, the above example could
5049 be achieved in a single @command{sort} invocation by sorting the
5050 IPv4 address field using a @samp{V} version type, like @samp{-k1,1V}.
5053 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
5056 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
5059 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
5060 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
5062 by the sort operation.
5064 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
5066 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
5067 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0},
5068 @c then using sort's @option{-z} option,
5069 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
5072 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n' |
5073 @c perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g' |
5075 @c perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
5079 Use the common DSU, Decorate Sort Undecorate idiom to
5080 sort lines according to their length.
5083 awk '@{print length, $0@}' /etc/passwd | sort -n | cut -f2- -d' '
5086 In general this technique can be used to sort data that the @command{sort}
5087 command does not support, or is inefficient at, sorting directly.
5090 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
5091 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
5092 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
5096 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
5102 @node shuf invocation
5103 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
5106 @cindex shuffling files
5108 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
5109 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
5113 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
5114 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
5115 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
5118 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
5119 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
5120 input. The following options change the operation mode:
5128 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
5129 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
5131 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
5132 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
5134 @opindex --input-range
5135 @cindex input range to shuffle
5136 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
5137 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
5141 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
5146 @item -n @var{count}
5147 @itemx --head-count=@var{count}
5149 @opindex --head-count
5150 @cindex head of output
5151 Output at most @var{count} lines. By default, all input lines are
5154 @item -o @var{output-file}
5155 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
5158 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
5159 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
5160 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
5161 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
5162 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
5164 @item --random-source=@var{file}
5165 @opindex --random-source
5166 @cindex random source for shuffling
5167 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
5168 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
5174 @cindex repeat output values
5175 Repeat output values, that is, select with replacement. With this
5176 option the output is not a permutation of the input; instead, each
5177 output line is randomly chosen from all the inputs. This option is
5178 typically combined with @option{--head-count}; if
5179 @option{--head-count} is not given, @command{shuf} repeats
5198 might produce the output
5208 Similarly, the command:
5211 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
5225 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
5235 The above examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
5236 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
5237 general, if there are @var{n} input lines, there are @var{n}! (i.e.,
5238 @var{n} factorial, or @var{n} * (@var{n} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
5239 output permutations.
5242 To output 50 random numbers each in the range 0 through 9, use:
5245 shuf -r -n 50 -i 0-9
5249 To simulate 100 coin flips, use:
5252 shuf -r -n 100 -e Head Tail
5258 @node uniq invocation
5259 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
5262 @cindex uniquify files
5264 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
5265 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
5269 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5272 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
5273 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
5274 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
5275 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
5277 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
5278 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
5279 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
5280 @xref{sort invocation}.
5283 Comparisons honor the rules specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE}
5286 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
5289 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5294 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
5296 @opindex --skip-fields
5297 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
5298 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields.
5299 Fields are a sequence of blank characters followed by non-blank characters.
5300 Field numbers are one based, i.e., @option{-f 1} will skip the first
5301 field (which may optionally have leading blanks).
5303 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
5304 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
5307 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
5309 @opindex --skip-chars
5310 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
5311 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
5312 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
5314 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
5315 On systems not conforming to POSIX 1003.1-2001,
5316 @command{uniq} supports a traditional option syntax
5318 Although this traditional behavior can be controlled with the
5319 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
5320 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
5321 behavior depends on this variable.
5322 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
5323 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
5329 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
5332 @itemx --ignore-case
5334 @opindex --ignore-case
5335 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
5341 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
5342 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
5343 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
5347 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
5349 @opindex --all-repeated
5350 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
5351 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
5352 but discard lines that are not repeated.
5353 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
5354 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
5355 The optional @var{delimit-method}, supported with the long form option,
5356 specifies how to delimit groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the
5362 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
5363 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
5366 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
5367 @macro nulOutputNote
5368 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use a zero
5369 byte (ASCII NUL) instead of a newline as the delimiter.
5374 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
5375 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
5376 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
5377 may be better suited for output direct to users.
5381 @macro ambiguousGroupNote
5382 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
5383 blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
5384 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\\n'} to
5389 This is a GNU extension.
5390 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
5392 @item --group[=@var{delimit-method}]
5394 @cindex all lines, grouping
5395 Output all lines, and delimit each unique group.
5397 The optional @var{delimit-method} specifies how to delimit
5398 groups, and must be one of the following:
5403 Separate unique groups with a single delimiter.
5404 This is the default delimiting method if none is specified,
5405 and better suited for output direct to users.
5408 Output a delimiter before each group of unique items.
5411 Output a delimiter after each group of unique items.
5414 Output a delimiter around each group of unique items.
5419 This is a GNU extension.
5425 @cindex unique lines, outputting
5426 Discard the last line that would be output for a repeated input group.
5427 When used by itself, this option causes @command{uniq} to print unique
5428 lines, and nothing else.
5431 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
5433 @opindex --check-chars
5434 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
5435 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
5439 @newlineFieldSeparator
5446 @node comm invocation
5447 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
5450 @cindex line-by-line comparison
5451 @cindex comparing sorted files
5453 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
5454 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
5455 standard input. Synopsis:
5458 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5462 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
5463 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
5464 If an input file ends in a non-newline
5465 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
5466 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
5468 @cindex differing lines
5469 @cindex common lines
5470 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
5471 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
5472 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
5473 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
5474 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
5475 @c string, append "by default" to the above sentence.
5480 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
5481 the corresponding columns (and separators). Also see @ref{Common options}.
5483 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
5484 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
5485 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
5486 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
5488 @macro checkOrderOption{cmd}
5489 If the @option{--check-order} option is given, unsorted inputs will
5490 cause a fatal error message. If the option @option{--nocheck-order}
5491 is given, unsorted inputs will never cause an error message. If neither
5492 of these options is given, wrongly sorted inputs are diagnosed
5493 only if an input file is found to contain unpairable
5495 lines, and when both input files are non empty.
5497 @ifclear JOIN_COMMAND
5500 If an input file is diagnosed as being unsorted, the @command{\cmd\}
5501 command will exit with a nonzero status (and the output should not be used).
5503 Forcing @command{\cmd\} to process wrongly sorted input files
5504 containing unpairable lines by specifying @option{--nocheck-order} is
5505 not guaranteed to produce any particular output. The output will
5506 probably not correspond with whatever you hoped it would be.
5508 @checkOrderOption{comm}
5513 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
5515 @item --nocheck-order
5516 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order.
5520 @item --output-delimiter=@var{str}
5521 Print @var{str} between adjacent output columns,
5522 rather than the default of a single TAB character.
5524 The delimiter @var{str} may be empty, in which case
5525 the ASCII NUL character is used to delimit output columns.
5528 Output a summary at the end.
5530 Similar to the regular output,
5531 column one contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file1},
5532 column two contains the total number of lines unique to @var{file2}, and
5533 column three contains the total number of lines common to both files,
5534 followed by the word @samp{total} in the additional column four.
5536 In the following example, @command{comm} omits the regular output
5537 (@option{-123}), thus just printing the summary:
5540 $ printf '%s\n' a b c d e > file1
5541 $ printf '%s\n' b c d e f g > file2
5542 $ comm --total -123 file1 file2
5546 This option is a GNU extension. Portable scripts should use @command{wc} to
5547 get the totals, e.g. for the above example files:
5550 $ comm -23 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file1
5552 $ comm -13 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines only in file2
5554 $ comm -12 file1 file2 | wc -l # number of lines common to both files
5562 @node ptx invocation
5563 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
5567 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
5568 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
5571 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
5572 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
5575 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
5576 all GNU extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
5577 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
5578 When @option{-G} is not specified, GNU extensions are always enabled.
5579 GNU extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
5580 document. @xref{Compatibility in ptx}, for the full list.
5582 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
5584 When GNU extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
5585 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
5586 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
5587 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
5588 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
5589 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
5590 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
5591 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
5594 When GNU extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
5595 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
5596 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
5597 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
5598 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
5599 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
5600 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
5601 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
5602 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
5603 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
5604 compatibility; GNU Standards normally discourage output parameters not
5605 introduced by an option.
5607 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
5608 input text file, a single dash @samp{-} may be used, in which case
5609 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
5610 convention more than once per program invocation.
5613 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
5614 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
5615 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
5616 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
5617 * Compatibility in ptx::
5621 @node General options in ptx
5622 @subsection General options
5627 @itemx --traditional
5628 As already explained, this option disables all GNU extensions to
5629 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
5632 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
5636 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
5644 @node Charset selection in ptx
5645 @subsection Charset selection
5647 As it is set up now, @command{ptx} assumes that the input file is coded
5648 using 8-bit characters, and it may not work well in multibyte locales.
5649 In a single-byte locale, the default regular expression
5650 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
5651 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
5654 The output of @command{ptx} assumes the locale's character encoding.
5655 For example, with @command{ptx}'s @option{-T} option, if the locale
5656 uses the Latin-1 encoding you may need a LaTeX directive like
5657 @samp{\usepackage[latin1]@{inputenc@}} to render non-ASCII characters
5663 @itemx --ignore-case
5665 @opindex --ignore-case
5666 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
5671 @node Input processing in ptx
5672 @subsection Word selection and input processing
5677 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
5679 @opindex --break-file
5681 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
5682 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
5683 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
5684 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
5685 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
5686 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
5687 @option{-b} is ignored.
5689 When GNU extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
5690 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
5691 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When GNU extensions
5692 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
5693 characters even if not included in the Break file.
5696 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
5698 @opindex --ignore-file
5700 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5701 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
5702 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
5703 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
5707 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
5709 @opindex --only-file
5711 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
5712 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
5713 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
5714 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
5715 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
5717 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
5718 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
5719 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
5724 @opindex --references
5726 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
5727 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
5728 line in the resulting permuted index.
5729 @xref{Output formatting in ptx},
5730 for more information about reference production.
5731 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
5733 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
5734 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
5735 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
5736 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when GNU extensions
5737 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
5738 excluded from the output contexts.
5740 @item -S @var{regexp}
5741 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
5743 @opindex --sentence-regexp
5745 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
5746 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
5747 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
5748 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
5749 default, when GNU extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
5750 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
5751 imported from GNU Emacs:
5754 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
5757 Whenever GNU extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
5758 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
5764 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
5765 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
5766 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
5767 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
5768 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5771 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
5772 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
5773 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
5774 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
5775 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
5776 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
5777 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
5778 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
5779 on the right of the output line.
5781 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5782 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
5783 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5785 @item -W @var{regexp}
5786 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
5788 @opindex --word-regexp
5790 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
5791 By default, if GNU extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
5792 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When GNU extensions are
5793 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
5794 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
5796 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
5797 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
5800 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5801 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5802 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5807 @node Output formatting in ptx
5808 @subsection Output formatting
5810 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
5811 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
5812 selected, and if GNU extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
5813 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
5814 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
5815 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
5816 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
5817 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
5818 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
5819 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with GNU
5820 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
5821 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
5822 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
5823 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
5824 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
5825 characters is transmitted verbatim.
5827 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
5831 @item -g @var{number}
5832 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
5836 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
5839 @item -w @var{number}
5840 @itemx --width=@var{number}
5844 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
5845 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
5846 depending on the value of option @option{-R}@. If this option is not
5847 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
5848 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
5849 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
5850 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
5851 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
5855 @itemx --auto-reference
5857 @opindex --auto-reference
5859 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
5860 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
5861 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
5862 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
5863 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
5864 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
5867 @itemx --right-side-refs
5869 @opindex --right-side-refs
5871 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
5872 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
5873 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
5874 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
5875 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
5876 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
5877 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
5878 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
5880 This option is automatically selected whenever GNU extensions are
5883 @item -F @var{string}
5884 @itemx --flag-truncation=@var{string}
5886 @opindex --flag-truncation
5888 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
5889 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
5890 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
5891 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}@. But there is a maximum
5892 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
5893 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
5894 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
5895 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
5896 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
5898 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F @dots{}}.
5899 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
5900 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
5903 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
5904 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
5905 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
5907 @item -M @var{string}
5908 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
5910 @opindex --macro-name
5912 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
5913 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
5916 @itemx --format=roff
5918 @opindex --format=roff
5920 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
5921 processing. Each output line will look like:
5924 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}"@c
5925 "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
5928 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
5929 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when GNU
5930 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
5931 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
5933 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
5934 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
5935 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character @samp{"} is doubled
5936 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
5941 @opindex --format=tex
5943 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
5944 line will look like:
5947 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@c
5948 @{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
5952 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
5953 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
5954 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
5955 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
5956 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
5959 In this output format, some special characters, like @samp{$}, @samp{%},
5960 @samp{&}, @samp{#} and @samp{_} are automatically protected with a
5961 backslash. Curly brackets @samp{@{}, @samp{@}} are protected with a
5962 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
5963 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
5964 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
5965 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
5966 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
5967 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
5968 and all other characters which are not part of ASCII, are merely
5969 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
5970 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
5971 processing for @TeX{}.
5976 @node Compatibility in ptx
5977 @subsection The GNU extensions to @command{ptx}
5979 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
5980 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
5981 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
5982 options. Some GNU extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
5983 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about GNU extensions.
5984 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
5989 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
5990 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
5991 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
5992 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
5995 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
5996 practice which GNU avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
5997 portably between GNU and System V, you should always use it with a
5998 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
5999 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
6000 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
6001 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
6004 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
6005 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
6006 @option{-w}. All other options are GNU extensions and are not repeated in
6007 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
6008 meaning when GNU extensions are enabled, as explained below.
6011 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
6012 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
6013 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
6016 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
6017 subtracted from the total output line width. With GNU extensions
6018 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
6019 line width computations.
6022 All 256 bytes, even ASCII NUL bytes, are always read and
6023 processed from input file with no adverse effect, even if GNU extensions
6024 are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit
6025 characters, a few control characters are rejected, and the tilde
6026 @samp{~} is also rejected.
6029 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if GNU
6030 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
6031 the first 200 characters in each line.
6034 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
6035 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When GNU
6036 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
6040 The program makes better use of output line width. If GNU extensions
6041 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
6042 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
6043 not completely reproduce.
6046 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
6047 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
6052 @node tsort invocation
6053 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
6056 @cindex topological sort
6058 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
6059 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
6060 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
6064 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
6067 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
6068 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
6069 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
6083 will produce the output
6094 Consider a more realistic example.
6095 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
6096 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
6097 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
6098 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
6099 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
6100 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
6101 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
6102 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
6103 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
6104 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
6105 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
6106 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
6112 tail_file pretty_name
6113 tail_file write_header
6115 tail_forever recheck
6116 tail_forever pretty_name
6117 tail_forever write_header
6118 tail_forever dump_remainder
6121 tail_lines start_lines
6122 tail_lines dump_remainder
6123 tail_lines file_lines
6124 tail_lines pipe_lines
6126 tail_bytes start_bytes
6127 tail_bytes dump_remainder
6128 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
6129 file_lines dump_remainder
6133 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
6134 functions that satisfies your requirement.
6137 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
6157 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
6158 encountered to standard error.
6160 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
6161 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
6162 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
6163 precedes @code{main}.
6165 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
6171 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
6174 @node tsort background
6175 @subsection @command{tsort}: Background
6177 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
6178 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
6179 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
6180 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
6183 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
6184 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
6185 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
6186 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
6187 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
6188 reference to @code{read}.
6190 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
6191 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
6192 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
6193 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
6196 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
6197 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
6199 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
6200 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
6201 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
6202 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
6205 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
6206 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
6210 @node Operating on fields
6211 @chapter Operating on fields
6214 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
6215 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
6216 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
6220 @node cut invocation
6221 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
6224 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
6225 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
6229 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6232 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
6233 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
6234 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
6235 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
6236 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
6237 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
6238 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
6239 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
6240 is written exactly once.
6242 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
6247 @item -b @var{byte-list}
6248 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
6251 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
6252 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
6253 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
6254 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
6255 string between ranges of selected bytes.
6257 @item -c @var{character-list}
6258 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
6260 @opindex --characters
6261 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
6262 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
6263 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
6264 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
6265 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
6266 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
6269 @item -f @var{field-list}
6270 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
6273 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
6274 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
6275 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
6276 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified.
6278 Note @command{awk} supports more sophisticated field processing,
6279 like reordering fields, and handling fields aligned with blank characters.
6280 By default @command{awk} uses (and discards) runs of blank characters
6281 to separate fields, and ignores leading and trailing blanks.
6284 awk '{print $2}' # print the second field
6285 awk '{print $(NF-1)}' # print the penultimate field
6286 awk '{print $2,$1}' # reorder the first two fields
6289 Note while @command{cut} accepts field specifications in
6290 arbitrary order, output is always in the order encountered in the file.
6292 In the unlikely event that @command{awk} is unavailable,
6293 one can use the @command{join} command, to process blank
6294 characters as @command{awk} does above.
6297 join -a1 -o 1.2 - /dev/null # print the second field
6298 join -a1 -o 1.2,1.1 - /dev/null # reorder the first two fields
6302 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
6303 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
6305 @opindex --delimiter
6306 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
6307 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
6311 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
6314 @itemx --only-delimited
6316 @opindex --only-delimited
6317 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
6318 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
6320 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
6321 @opindex --output-delimiter
6322 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
6323 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
6324 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
6325 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
6326 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
6327 ranges of selected bytes.
6330 @opindex --complement
6331 This option is a GNU extension.
6332 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
6333 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
6334 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
6335 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
6336 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
6345 @node paste invocation
6346 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
6349 @cindex merging files
6351 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
6352 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
6353 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
6359 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
6373 Take lines sequentially from each file:
6381 Duplicate lines from a file:
6383 $ paste num2 let3 num2
6389 Intermix lines from standard input:
6391 $ paste - let3 - < num2
6397 Join consecutive lines with a space:
6399 $ seq 4 | paste -d ' ' - -
6404 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6412 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
6413 file. Using the above example data:
6416 $ paste -s num2 let3
6421 @item -d @var{delim-list}
6422 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
6424 @opindex --delimiters
6425 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
6426 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
6427 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
6430 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
6443 @node join invocation
6444 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
6447 @cindex common field, joining on
6449 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
6450 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
6453 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
6456 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
6457 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
6458 sorted on the join fields.
6480 @command{join}'s default behavior (when no options are given):
6482 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
6483 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
6484 blanks on the line ignored;
6485 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
6486 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
6487 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
6492 * General options in join:: Options which affect general program behavior.
6493 * Sorting files for join:: Using @command{sort} before @command{join}.
6494 * Working with fields:: Joining on different fields.
6495 * Paired and unpaired lines:: Controlling @command{join}'s field matching.
6496 * Header lines:: Working with header lines in files.
6497 * Set operations:: Union, Intersection and Difference of files.
6500 @node General options in join
6501 @subsection General options
6502 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6506 @item -a @var{file-number}
6508 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
6509 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
6512 Fail with an error message if either input file is wrongly ordered.
6514 @item --nocheck-order
6515 Do not check that both input files are in sorted order. This is the default.
6517 @item -e @var{string}
6519 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with @var{string}.
6520 I.e., missing fields specified with the @option{-12jo} options.
6524 Treat the first line of each input file as a header line. The header lines
6525 will be joined and printed as the first output line. If @option{-o} is used to
6526 specify output format, the header line will be printed according to the
6527 specified format. The header lines will not be checked for ordering even if
6528 @option{--check-order} is specified. Also if the header lines from each file
6529 do not match, the heading fields from the first file will be used.
6532 @itemx --ignore-case
6534 @opindex --ignore-case
6535 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
6536 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
6537 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
6539 @item -1 @var{field}
6541 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
6543 @item -2 @var{field}
6545 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
6547 @item -j @var{field}
6548 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
6550 @item -o @var{field-list}
6552 If the keyword @samp{auto} is specified, infer the output format from
6553 the first line in each file. This is the same as the default output format
6554 but also ensures the same number of fields are output for each line.
6555 Missing fields are replaced with the @option{-e} option and extra fields
6558 Otherwise, construct each output line according to the format in
6559 @var{field-list}. Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single
6560 character @samp{0} or has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m},
6561 is @samp{1} or @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
6563 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
6564 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
6565 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
6566 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
6567 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
6568 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
6569 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
6570 To give @command{join} that functionality, POSIX invented the @samp{0}
6571 field specification notation.
6573 The elements in @var{field-list}
6574 are separated by commas or blanks.
6575 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
6576 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
6577 2.2'} are equivalent.
6579 All output lines -- including those printed because of any @option{-a}
6580 or @option{-v} option -- are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
6583 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
6584 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
6585 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
6586 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering. If @samp{join -t ''} is specified,
6587 the whole line is considered, matching the default operation of sort.
6588 If @samp{-t '\0'} is specified then the ASCII NUL
6589 character is used to delimit the fields.
6591 @item -v @var{file-number}
6592 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
6593 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
6596 @newlineFieldSeparator
6603 @checkOrderOption{join}
6608 @node Sorting files for join
6609 @subsection Pre-sorting
6611 @command{join} requires sorted input files. Each input file should be
6612 sorted according to the key (=field/column number) used in
6613 @command{join}. The recommended sorting option is @samp{sort -k 1b,1}
6614 (assuming the desired key is in the first column).
6616 @noindent Typical usage:
6619 $ sort -k 1b,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6620 $ sort -k 1b,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6621 $ join file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6626 Normally, the sort order is that of the
6627 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
6628 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
6629 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
6630 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
6631 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}:
6635 $ sort -k 1bf,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6636 $ sort -k 1bf,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6637 $ join --ignore-case file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6641 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
6642 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
6643 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
6644 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
6645 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
6646 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
6648 @noindent To avoid any locale-related issues, it is recommended to use the
6649 @samp{C} locale for both commands:
6653 $ LC_ALL=C sort -k 1b,1 file1 > file1.sorted
6654 $ LC_ALL=C sort -k 1b,1 file2 > file2.sorted
6655 $ LC_ALL=C join file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6660 @node Working with fields
6661 @subsection Working with fields
6663 Use @option{-1},@option{-2} to set the key fields for each of the input files.
6664 Ensure the preceding @command{sort} commands operated on the same fields.
6667 The following example joins two files, using the values from seventh field
6668 of the first file and the third field of the second file:
6672 $ sort -k 7b,7 file1 > file1.sorted
6673 $ sort -k 3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6674 $ join -1 7 -2 3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6679 If the field number is the same for both files, use @option{-j}:
6683 $ sort -k4b,4 file1 > file1.sorted
6684 $ sort -k4b,4 file2 > file2.sorted
6685 $ join -j4 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6690 Both @command{sort} and @command{join} operate of whitespace-delimited
6691 fields. To specify a different delimiter, use @option{-t} in @emph{both}:
6695 $ sort -t, -k3b,3 file1 > file1.sorted
6696 $ sort -t, -k3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6697 $ join -t, -j3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6702 To specify a tab (@sc{ascii} 0x09) character instead of whitespace,
6703 use:@footnote{the @code{$'\t'} is supported in most modern shells.
6704 For older shells, use a literal tab.}
6708 $ sort -t$'\t' -k3b,3 file1 > file1.sorted
6709 $ sort -t$'\t' -k3b,3 file2 > file2.sorted
6710 $ join -t$'\t' -j3 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6716 If @samp{join -t ''} is specified then the whole line is considered which
6717 matches the default operation of sort:
6721 $ sort file1 > file1.sorted
6722 $ sort file2 > file2.sorted
6723 $ join -t '' file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6728 @node Paired and unpaired lines
6729 @subsection Controlling @command{join}'s field matching
6731 In this section the @command{sort} commands are omitted for brevity.
6732 Sorting the files before joining is still required.
6734 @command{join}'s default behavior is to print only lines common to
6735 both input files. Use @option{-a} and @option{-v} to print unpairable lines
6736 from one or both files.
6739 All examples below use the following two (pre-sorted) input files:
6741 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
6758 @c TODO: Find better column widths that work for both HTML and PDF
6759 @c and disable indentation of @example.
6760 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
6762 @headitem Command @tab Outcome
6772 (@emph{intersection})
6778 $ join -a 1 file1 file2
6783 common lines @emph{and} unpaired
6784 lines from the first file
6789 $ join -a 2 file1 file2
6794 common lines @emph{and} unpaired lines from the second file
6799 $ join -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6805 all lines (paired and unpaired) from both files
6808 see note below regarding @code{-o auto}.
6813 $ join -v 1 file1 file2
6817 unpaired lines from the first file
6823 $ join -v 2 file1 file2
6827 unpaired lines from the second file
6833 $ join -v 1 -v 2 file1 file2
6838 unpaired lines from both files, omitting common lines
6839 (@emph{symmetric difference}).
6845 The @option{-o auto -e X} options are useful when dealing with unpaired lines.
6846 The following example prints all lines (common and unpaired) from both files.
6847 Without @option{-o auto} it is not easy to discern which fields originate from
6851 $ join -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6856 $ join -o auto -e X -a 1 -a 2 file1 file2
6863 If the input has no unpairable lines, a GNU extension is
6864 available; the sort order can be any order that considers two fields
6865 to be equal if and only if the sort comparison described above
6866 considers them to be equal. For example:
6889 @subsection Header lines
6891 The @option{--header} option can be used when the files to join
6892 have a header line which is not sorted:
6906 $ join --header -o auto -e NA -a1 -a2 file1 file2
6915 To sort a file with a header line, use GNU @command{sed -u}.
6916 The following example sort the files but keeps the first line of each
6921 $ ( sed -u 1q ; sort -k2b,2 ) < file1 > file1.sorted
6922 $ ( sed -u 1q ; sort -k2b,2 ) < file2 > file2.sorted
6923 $ join --header -o auto -e NA -a1 -a2 file1.sorted file2.sorted > file3
6927 @node Set operations
6928 @subsection Union, Intersection and Difference of files
6930 Combine @command{sort}, @command{uniq} and @command{join} to
6931 perform the equivalent of set operations on files:
6933 @c From https://www.pixelbeat.org/cmdline.html#sets
6934 @multitable @columnfractions 0.5 0.5
6935 @headitem Command @tab outcome
6936 @item @code{sort -u file1 file2}
6937 @tab Union of unsorted files
6939 @item @code{sort file1 file2 | uniq -d}
6940 @tab Intersection of unsorted files
6942 @item @code{sort file1 file1 file2 | uniq -u}
6943 @tab Difference of unsorted files
6945 @item @code{sort file1 file2 | uniq -u}
6946 @tab Symmetric Difference of unsorted files
6948 @item @code{join -t '' -a1 -a2 file1 file2}
6949 @tab Union of sorted files
6951 @item @code{join -t '' file1 file2}
6952 @tab Intersection of sorted files
6954 @item @code{join -t '' -v2 file1 file2}
6955 @tab Difference of sorted files
6957 @item @code{join -t '' -v1 -v2 file1 file2}
6958 @tab Symmetric Difference of sorted files
6962 All examples above operate on entire lines and not on specific fields:
6963 @command{sort} without @option{-k} and @command{join -t ''} both consider
6964 entire lines as the key.
6967 @node Operating on characters
6968 @chapter Operating on characters
6970 @cindex operating on characters
6972 These commands operate on individual characters.
6975 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
6976 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
6977 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
6982 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
6989 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{string1} [@var{string2}]
6992 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
6993 one of the following operations:
6997 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
6999 squeeze repeated characters,
7003 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
7006 The @var{string1} and @var{string2} operands define arrays of
7007 characters @var{array1} and @var{array2}. By default @var{array1}
7008 lists input characters that @command{tr} operates on, and @var{array2}
7009 lists corresponding translations. In some cases the second operand is
7012 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7013 Options must precede operands.
7022 @opindex --complement
7023 Instead of @var{array1}, use its complement (all characters not
7024 specified by @var{string1}), in ascending order. Use this option with
7025 caution in multibyte locales where its meaning is not always clear
7026 or portable; see @ref{Character arrays}.
7032 Delete characters in @var{array1}; do not translate.
7035 @itemx --squeeze-repeats
7037 @opindex --squeeze-repeats
7038 Replace each sequence of a repeated character that is listed in
7039 the last specified @var{array}, with a single occurrence of that character.
7042 @itemx --truncate-set1
7044 @opindex --truncate-set1
7045 Truncate @var{array1} to the length of @var{array2}.
7053 * Character arrays:: Specifying arrays of characters.
7054 * Translating:: Changing characters to other characters.
7055 * Squeezing and deleting:: Removing characters.
7059 @node Character arrays
7060 @subsection Specifying arrays of characters
7062 @cindex arrays of characters in @command{tr}
7064 The @var{string1} and @var{string2} operands are not regular
7065 expressions, even though they may look similar. Instead, they
7066 merely represent arrays of characters. As a GNU extension to POSIX,
7067 an empty string operand represents an empty array of characters.
7069 The interpretation of @var{string1} and @var{string2} depends on locale.
7070 GNU @command{tr} fully supports only safe single-byte locales,
7071 where each possible input byte represents a single character.
7072 Unfortunately, this means GNU @command{tr} will not handle commands
7073 like @samp{tr @"o @L{}} the way you might expect,
7074 since (assuming a UTF-8 encoding) this is equivalent to
7075 @samp{tr '\303\266' '\305\201'} and GNU @command{tr} will
7076 simply transliterate all @samp{\303} bytes to @samp{\305} bytes, etc.
7077 POSIX does not clearly specify the behavior of @command{tr} in locales
7078 where characters are represented by byte sequences instead of by
7079 individual bytes, or where data might contain invalid bytes that are
7080 encoding errors. To avoid problems in this area, you can run
7081 @command{tr} in a safe single-byte locale by using a shell command
7082 like @samp{LC_ALL=C tr} instead of plain @command{tr}.
7084 Although most characters simply represent themselves in @var{string1}
7085 and @var{string2}, the strings can contain shorthands listed below,
7086 for convenience. Some shorthands can be used only in @var{string1} or
7087 @var{string2}, as noted below.
7091 @item Backslash escapes
7092 @cindex backslash escapes
7094 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
7098 Bell (BEL, Control-G).
7100 Backspace (BS, Control-H).
7102 Form feed (FF, Control-L).
7104 Newline (LF, Control-J).
7106 Carriage return (CR, Control-M).
7108 Tab (HT, Control-I).
7110 Vertical tab (VT, Control-K).
7112 The eight-bit byte with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is the longest
7113 sequence of one to three octal digits following the backslash.
7114 For portability, @var{ooo} should represent a value that fits in eight bits.
7115 As a GNU extension to POSIX, if the value would not fit, then only the
7116 first two digits of @var{ooo} are used, e.g., @samp{\400}
7117 is equivalent to @samp{\0400} and represents a two-byte sequence.
7122 It is an error if no character follows an unescaped backslash.
7123 As a GNU extension, a backslash followed by a character not listed
7124 above is interpreted as that character, removing any special
7125 significance; this can be used to escape the characters
7126 @samp{[} and @samp{-} when they would otherwise be special.
7131 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to the characters
7132 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
7133 not collate after @var{n}; if it does, an error results. As an example,
7134 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
7136 GNU @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
7137 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
7138 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
7139 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
7140 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
7143 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not fully
7144 portable. For example, on EBCDIC hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
7145 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
7146 are not contiguous as they are in ASCII@.
7147 One way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
7148 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
7151 @item Repeated characters
7152 @cindex repeated characters
7154 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{string2} expands to @var{n}
7155 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
7156 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
7157 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{array2} as long as
7158 @var{array1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
7159 octal, otherwise in decimal. A zero-valued @var{n} is treated as if
7162 @item Character classes
7163 @cindex character classes
7165 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all characters in
7166 the (predefined) class @var{class}. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
7167 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
7168 character class can be used in @var{string2}. Otherwise, only the
7169 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
7170 @var{string2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
7171 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
7172 relative position in @var{string1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
7173 Except for case conversion, a class's characters appear in no particular order.
7174 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
7186 Horizontal whitespace.
7195 Printable characters, not including space.
7201 Printable characters, including space.
7204 Punctuation characters.
7207 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
7216 @item Equivalence classes
7217 @cindex equivalence classes
7219 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all characters equivalent to
7220 @var{c}, in no particular order. These equivalence classes are
7221 allowed in @var{string2} only when @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) and
7222 @option{--squeeze-repeats} @option{-s} are both given.
7224 Although equivalence classes are intended to support non-English alphabets,
7225 there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
7226 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in GNU @command{tr};
7227 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
7228 which is of no particular use.
7234 @subsection Translating
7236 @cindex translating characters
7238 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{string1} and @var{string2} are
7239 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
7240 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{array1}
7241 to the corresponding character in @var{array2}. Characters not in
7242 @var{array1} are passed through unchanged.
7244 As a GNU extension to POSIX, when a character appears more than once
7245 in @var{array1}, only the final instance is used. For example, these
7246 two commands are equivalent:
7253 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
7254 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
7257 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
7259 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
7263 However, ranges like @code{a-z} are not portable outside the C locale.
7265 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{array1} and @var{array2}
7266 typically have the same length. If @var{array1} is shorter than
7267 @var{array2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{array2} are ignored.
7269 On the other hand, making @var{array1} longer than @var{array2} is not
7270 portable; POSIX says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
7271 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{array2} to the length of @var{array1} by repeating
7272 the last character of @var{array2} as many times as necessary. System V
7273 @command{tr} truncates @var{array1} to the length of @var{array2}.
7275 By default, GNU @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
7276 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
7277 GNU @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
7278 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
7280 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
7284 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
7288 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
7289 complement of @var{array1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
7293 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
7294 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012. Here is a better
7298 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
7302 @node Squeezing and deleting
7303 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
7305 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
7306 @cindex deleting characters
7307 @cindex removing characters
7309 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
7310 removes any input characters that are in @var{array1}.
7312 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option
7313 and not translating, @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a
7314 repeated character that is in @var{array1} with a single occurrence of
7317 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
7318 first performs any deletions using @var{array1}, then squeezes repeats
7319 from any remaining characters using @var{array2}.
7321 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
7322 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
7323 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{array2}.
7325 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
7330 Remove all zero bytes:
7337 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
7338 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
7339 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
7342 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
7346 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline.
7347 I.e., delete empty lines:
7354 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
7355 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
7356 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
7357 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
7358 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
7359 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
7360 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
7361 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
7367 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
7368 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
7373 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
7374 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
7380 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
7381 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
7382 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
7383 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
7384 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
7385 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
7386 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
7387 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
7388 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
7395 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
7404 @node expand invocation
7405 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
7408 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
7409 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
7411 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
7412 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
7413 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
7417 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7420 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
7421 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
7422 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
7423 tabs every 8 columns).
7425 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7429 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7430 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7433 @cindex tab stops, setting
7434 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
7435 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
7436 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
7437 last tab stop given with single spaces.
7438 @macro gnuExpandTabs
7439 Tab stops can be separated by blanks as well as by commas.
7441 As a GNU extension the last @var{tab} specified can be prefixed
7442 with a @samp{/} to indicate a tab size to use for remaining positions.
7443 For example, @option{--tabs=2,4,/8} will set tab stops at position 2 and 4,
7444 and every multiple of 8 after that.
7446 Also the last @var{tab} specified can be prefixed with a @samp{+} to indicate
7447 a tab size to use for remaining positions, offset from the final explicitly
7449 For example, to ignore the 1 character gutter present in diff output,
7450 one can specify a 1 character offset using @option{--tabs=1,+8},
7451 which will set tab stops at positions 1,9,17,@dots{}
7456 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
7457 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
7458 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
7464 @cindex initial tabs, converting
7465 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
7466 characters) on each line to spaces.
7473 @node unexpand invocation
7474 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
7478 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
7479 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
7480 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
7481 as many tab characters as needed. In the default POSIX
7482 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
7483 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
7486 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7489 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
7490 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
7491 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
7492 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
7495 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7499 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7500 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
7503 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
7504 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
7505 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
7506 beyond the tab stops given unchanged.
7509 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
7511 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
7512 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
7513 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
7514 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
7515 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
7521 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
7522 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
7529 @node Directory listing
7530 @chapter Directory listing
7532 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
7533 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
7536 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
7537 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
7538 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
7539 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
7544 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
7547 @cindex directory listing
7549 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
7550 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
7551 arbitrarily, as usual. Later options override earlier options that
7554 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
7555 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
7556 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
7557 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
7558 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
7559 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
7562 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
7563 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-POSIX
7564 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
7565 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
7566 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
7567 If standard output is
7568 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
7569 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
7570 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
7572 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
7573 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
7574 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
7575 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
7576 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
7578 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
7583 1 minor problems (e.g., failure to access a file or directory not
7584 specified as a command line argument. This happens when listing a
7585 directory in which entries are actively being removed or renamed.)
7586 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted, invalid option, failure
7587 to access a file or directory specified as a command line argument
7588 or a directory loop)
7591 Also see @ref{Common options}.
7594 * Which files are listed::
7595 * What information is listed::
7596 * Sorting the output::
7597 * General output formatting::
7598 * Formatting file timestamps::
7599 * Formatting the file names::
7603 @node Which files are listed
7604 @subsection Which files are listed
7606 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
7607 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
7608 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
7609 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
7617 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
7622 @opindex --almost-all
7623 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
7624 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
7625 option overrides this option.
7628 @itemx --ignore-backups
7630 @opindex --ignore-backups
7631 @cindex backup files, ignoring
7632 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
7633 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
7638 @opindex --directory
7639 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
7640 than listing their contents.
7641 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
7642 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
7643 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
7644 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7645 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
7648 @itemx --dereference-command-line
7650 @opindex --dereference-command-line
7651 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7652 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
7653 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
7655 @item --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
7656 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
7657 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7658 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
7659 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
7660 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
7662 This is the default behavior unless long format is being used
7663 or any of the following options is in effect:
7664 @option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
7665 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
7666 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
7667 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
7669 @item --group-directories-first
7670 @opindex --group-directories-first
7671 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
7672 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
7673 (see @option{--sort} option).
7674 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
7675 and the @option{--sort} option specifies a secondary key.
7676 However, any use of @option{--sort=none}
7677 (@option{-U}) disables this option altogether.
7679 @item --hide=PATTERN
7680 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
7681 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
7682 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
7683 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
7684 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
7685 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
7686 (@option{-A}) is also given.
7688 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
7689 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
7690 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
7691 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
7693 @item -I @var{pattern}
7694 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
7696 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
7697 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
7698 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
7699 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
7700 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
7701 to give this option several times. For example,
7704 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
7707 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
7708 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
7709 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
7712 @itemx --dereference
7714 @opindex --dereference
7715 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
7716 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
7717 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
7718 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
7719 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
7724 @opindex --recursive
7725 @cindex recursive directory listing
7726 @cindex directory listing, recursive
7727 List the contents of all directories recursively.
7732 @node What information is listed
7733 @subsection What information is listed
7735 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
7736 default, only file names are shown.
7742 @cindex hurd, author, printing
7743 In long format, list each file's author.
7744 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
7745 operating systems the two are the same.
7751 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
7752 Print an additional line after the main output:
7755 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
7759 The @var{begn} and @var{endn} are unsigned integers that record the
7760 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
7761 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
7762 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
7764 If directories are being listed recursively via
7765 @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}), output a similar
7766 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
7769 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
7772 Finally, output a line of the form:
7775 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
7779 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
7781 Here is an actual example:
7784 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
7786 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
7787 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
7790 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
7791 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
7792 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
7793 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
7797 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
7801 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
7805 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
7806 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
7807 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
7810 The pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
7811 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
7813 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
7814 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
7816 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
7817 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
7820 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
7821 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
7825 Although the listing above includes a trailing slash
7826 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
7827 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
7828 (@option{-D}) along with an option like
7829 @option{--escape} (@option{-b}) and operate
7830 on a file whose name contains special characters, the backslash
7835 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
7836 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
7838 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
7841 If you use a quoting style like @option{--quoting-style=c} (@option{-Q})
7842 that adds quote marks, then the offsets include the quote marks.
7843 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
7844 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
7845 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal}
7846 (@option{-N}) option on the command line, or else be
7847 prepared to parse the escaped names.
7849 The @option{--dired} (@option{-D}) option has well-defined behavior
7850 only when long format is in effect and hyperlinks are disabled (e.g.,
7851 @option{--hyperlink=none}).
7854 @opindex --full-time
7855 Produce long format, and list times in full. It is
7856 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} (@option{-l}) with
7857 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
7861 Produce long format, but omit owner information.
7867 Inhibit display of group information in long format.
7868 (This is the default in some non-GNU versions of @command{ls}, so we
7869 provide this option for compatibility.)
7877 @cindex inode number, printing
7878 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
7879 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
7880 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
7883 @itemx --format=long
7884 @itemx --format=verbose
7887 @opindex long ls @r{format}
7888 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
7889 Produce long format.
7890 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
7891 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
7892 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
7893 the modification timestamp (the mtime, @pxref{File timestamps}).
7894 If the owner or group name cannot be determined, print
7895 the owner or group ID instead, right-justified as a cue
7896 that it is a number rather than a textual name.
7897 Print question marks for other information that
7898 cannot be determined.
7900 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
7901 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7902 For example, @option{--human-readable} (@option{-h})
7903 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
7904 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
7905 separator of the current locale.
7907 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
7908 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the file system allocation
7909 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
7910 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
7911 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
7912 this is arguably a deficiency.
7914 The file type is one of the following characters:
7916 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
7924 character special file
7926 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
7932 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
7936 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
7938 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
7940 network special file (HP-UX)
7946 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
7950 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7952 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
7954 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
7956 some other file type
7959 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
7960 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
7961 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
7962 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
7966 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
7970 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
7971 executable bit is not set.
7974 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
7975 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
7976 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
7979 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
7980 other-executable bit is not set.
7983 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
7989 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
7990 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
7991 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
7992 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
7993 character, then there is such a method.
7995 GNU @command{ls} uses a @samp{.} character to indicate a file
7996 with a security context, but no other alternate access method.
7998 A file with any other combination of alternate access methods
7999 is marked with a @samp{+} character.
8002 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
8004 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
8005 @cindex numeric uid and gid
8006 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
8007 Produce long format, but
8008 display right-justified numeric user and group IDs
8009 instead of left-justified owner and group names.
8013 Produce long format, but omit group information.
8014 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} (@option{-l})
8015 with @option{--no-group} (@option{-G}).
8021 @cindex file system allocation
8022 @cindex size of files, reporting
8023 Print the file system allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
8024 This is the amount of file system space used by the file, which is usually a
8025 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
8027 Normally the allocation is printed in units of
8028 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
8030 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
8031 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
8032 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
8033 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
8034 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
8035 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
8044 @cindex security context
8045 Display the SELinux security context or @samp{?} if none is found.
8046 In long format, print the security context to the left of the size column.
8051 @node Sorting the output
8052 @subsection Sorting the output
8054 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
8055 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
8056 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
8057 (e.g., ASCII order).
8063 @itemx --time=status
8066 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
8067 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
8068 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8070 print the status change timestamp (the ctime) instead of the mtime.
8071 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8072 sort according to the ctime. @xref{File timestamps}.
8076 @cindex unsorted directory listing
8077 @cindex directory order, listing by
8078 Produce an unsorted directory listing.
8079 This is equivalent to the combination of @option{--all} (@option{-a}),
8080 @option{--sort=none} (@option{-U}), @option{-1},
8081 @option{--color=none}, and @option{--hyperlink=none},
8082 while also disabling any previous use of @option{--size} (@option{-s}).
8088 @cindex reverse sorting
8089 Reverse whatever the sorting method is -- e.g., list files in reverse
8090 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
8091 This option has no effect when @option{--sort=none} (@option{-U})
8098 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
8099 Sort by file size, largest first.
8105 @opindex modification timestamp@r{, sorting files by}
8106 Sort by modification timestamp (mtime) by default, newest first.
8107 The timestamp to order by can be changed with the @option{--time} option.
8108 @xref{File timestamps}.
8112 @itemx --time=access
8116 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8117 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8118 @opindex access timestamp@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8119 In long format, print the last access timestamp (the atime).
8120 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8121 sort according to the atime.
8122 @xref{File timestamps}.
8125 @itemx --time=modification
8127 @opindex data modification time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8128 @opindex mtime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8129 This is the default timestamp display and sorting mode.
8130 In long format, print the last data modification timestamp (the mtime).
8131 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8132 sort according to the mtime.
8133 @xref{File timestamps}.
8136 @itemx --time=creation
8138 @opindex birth time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8139 @opindex creation timestamp@r{, printing or sorting files by}
8140 In long format, print the file creation timestamp if available,
8141 falling back to the file modification timestamp (mtime) if not.
8142 When sorting by time or when not using long format,
8143 sort according to the birth time.
8144 @xref{File timestamps}.
8150 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8151 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
8152 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
8153 that @option{-f} does.) This can be useful when listing large
8154 directories, where sorting can take some time.
8157 @itemx --sort=version
8160 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8161 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
8162 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
8163 as an index/version number. @xref{Version sort ordering}.
8167 @opindex width@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
8168 Sort by printed width of file names.
8169 This can be useful with the @option{--format=vertical} (@option{-C})
8170 output format, to most densely display the listed files.
8173 @itemx --sort=extension
8176 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
8177 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
8178 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
8183 @node General output formatting
8184 @subsection General output formatting
8186 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
8190 @item --format=single-column
8192 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
8193 List one file name per line, with no other information.
8194 This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
8195 output is not a terminal. See also the @option{--escape} (@option{-b}),
8196 @option{--hide-control-chars} (@option{-q}), and @option{--zero} options
8197 to disambiguate output of file names containing newline characters.
8201 List one file per line. This is like @option{--format=single-column}
8202 except that it has no effect if long format is also in effect.
8205 @itemx --format=vertical
8208 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
8209 List files in columns, sorted vertically, with no other information.
8210 This is the default for @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal.
8211 It is always the default for the @command{dir} program.
8212 GNU @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
8213 possible in the fewest lines.
8215 @item --color [=@var{when}]
8217 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
8218 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types; @var{when}
8219 may be omitted, or one of:
8222 @vindex none @r{color option}
8223 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
8225 @vindex auto @r{color option}
8226 @cindex terminal, using color iff
8227 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
8229 @vindex always @r{color option}
8232 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8233 @option{--color=always}.
8234 If piping a colored listing through a pager like @command{less},
8235 use the pager's @option{-R} option to pass the color codes to the terminal.
8238 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
8239 Using the @option{--color} option may incur a noticeable
8240 performance penalty when run in a large directory,
8241 because the default settings require that @command{ls} @code{stat} every
8242 single file it lists.
8243 However, if you would like most of the file-type coloring
8244 but can live without the other coloring options (e.g.,
8245 executable, orphan, sticky, other-writable, capability), use
8246 @command{dircolors} to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment variable like this,
8248 eval $(dircolors -p | perl -pe \
8249 's/^((CAP|S[ET]|O[TR]|M|E)\w+).*/$1 00/' | dircolors -)
8251 and on a @code{dirent.d_type}-capable file system, @command{ls}
8252 will perform only one @code{stat} call per command line argument.
8255 @itemx --classify [=@var{when}]
8256 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
8259 @opindex --indicator-style
8260 @cindex file type and executables, marking
8261 @cindex executables and file type, marking
8262 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
8263 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
8264 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
8265 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
8266 and nothing for regular files.
8267 @var{when} may be omitted, or one of:
8270 @vindex none @r{classify option}
8271 - Do not classify. This is the default.
8273 @vindex auto @r{classify option}
8274 @cindex terminal, using classify iff
8275 - Only classify if standard output is a terminal.
8277 @vindex always @r{classify option}
8280 Specifying @option{--classify} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8281 @option{--classify=always}.
8282 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
8283 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
8284 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
8285 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
8286 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
8289 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
8290 @opindex --file-type
8291 @opindex --indicator-style
8292 @cindex file type, marking
8293 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
8294 like @option{--classify} (@option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
8296 @item --hyperlink [=@var{when}]
8297 @opindex --hyperlink
8298 @cindex hyperlink, linking to files
8299 Output codes recognized by some terminals to link
8300 to files using the @samp{file://} URI format.
8301 @var{when} may be omitted, or one of:
8304 @vindex none @r{hyperlink option}
8305 - Do not use hyperlinks at all. This is the default.
8307 @vindex auto @r{hyperlink option}
8308 @cindex terminal, using hyperlink iff
8309 - Only use hyperlinks if standard output is a terminal.
8311 @vindex always @r{hyperlink option}
8312 - Always use hyperlinks.
8314 Specifying @option{--hyperlink} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
8315 @option{--hyperlink=always}.
8317 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
8318 @opindex --indicator-style
8319 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
8324 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
8326 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
8329 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
8330 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
8331 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
8333 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
8334 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{--classify}
8335 (@option{-F}) option.
8341 @opindex --kibibytes
8342 Set the default block size to its normal value of 1024 bytes,
8343 overriding any contrary specification in environment variables
8344 (@pxref{Block size}). If @option{--block-size},
8345 @option{--human-readable} (@option{-h}), or @option{--si} options are used,
8346 they take precedence even if @option{--kibibytes} (@option{-k}) is placed after
8348 The @option{--kibibytes} (@option{-k}) option affects the
8349 per-directory block count written in long format,
8350 and the file system allocation written by the @option{--size} (@option{-s})
8351 option. It does not affect the file size in bytes that is written in
8355 @itemx --format=commas
8358 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
8359 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
8360 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space),
8361 and with no other information.
8364 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
8366 @opindex --indicator-style
8367 @cindex file type, marking
8368 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
8371 @itemx --format=across
8372 @itemx --format=horizontal
8375 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
8376 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
8377 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
8380 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
8383 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
8384 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
8385 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
8387 Some terminal emulators might not properly align columns to the right of a
8388 TAB following a non-ASCII byte. You can avoid that issue by using the
8389 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment, to tell
8390 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
8392 If you set a terminal's hardware tabs to anything other than the default,
8393 you should also use a @command{--tabsize} option or @env{TABSIZE}
8394 environment variable either to match the hardware tabs, or to disable
8395 the use of hardware tabs. Otherwise, the output of @command{ls} may
8396 not line up. For example, if you run the shell command @samp{tabs -4}
8397 to set hardware tabs to every four columns, you should also run
8398 @samp{export TABSIZE=4} or @samp{export TABSIZE=0}, or use the
8399 corresponding @option{--tabsize} options.
8402 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
8406 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
8407 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
8408 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
8409 is 80. With a @var{cols} value of @samp{0}, there is no limit on
8410 the length of the output line, and that single output line will
8411 be delimited with spaces, not tabs.
8416 This option is incompatible with the @option{--dired} (@option{-D}) option.
8417 This option also implies the options @option{--show-control-chars},
8418 @option{-1}, @option{--color=none}, and
8419 @option{--quoting-style=literal} (@option{-N}).
8424 @node Formatting file timestamps
8425 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
8427 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form, using
8428 a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2020} for non-recent timestamps, and a
8429 date-without-year and time like @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
8430 This format can change depending on the current locale as detailed below.
8433 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
8434 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
8435 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
8436 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
8437 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
8438 @xref{File timestamps}.
8441 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
8442 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
8443 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
8444 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8446 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
8449 @item --time-style=@var{style}
8450 @opindex --time-style
8452 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
8453 be one of the following:
8458 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
8459 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
8460 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
8461 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2020-03-30 23:45:56}. As
8462 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
8463 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
8465 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
8466 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
8467 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
8468 spaces in one of the two formats.
8471 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601-like date, time, and time zone
8472 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21
8473 23:45:56.477817180 -0400}. This style is equivalent to
8474 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
8476 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
8477 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
8478 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since GNU @command{make}
8479 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
8482 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
8483 @samp{2020-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
8484 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
8485 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
8488 List ISO 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
8489 @samp{2020-03-30@ }), and ISO 8601-like month, day, hour, and
8490 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
8491 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
8492 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
8493 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
8494 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
8499 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
8500 ls -l --time-style="iso"
8505 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a French
8506 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{30 mars@ @ @ 2020}
8507 and recent timestamps like @samp{30 mars@ @ 23:45}. Locale-dependent
8508 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
8509 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
8510 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
8512 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
8513 default POSIX locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
8514 @ 2020} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
8515 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
8520 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
8521 ls -l --time-style="locale"
8524 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
8525 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
8526 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
8527 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2020@ } and
8528 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
8530 @item posix-@var{style}
8532 List POSIX-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
8533 category is POSIX, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
8534 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
8535 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2020} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
8536 the POSIX locale, and like @samp{2020-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
8541 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
8542 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
8543 the default style is @samp{locale}. GNU Emacs 21.3 and
8544 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
8545 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
8546 non-POSIX locale you may need to set
8547 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
8549 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
8550 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
8553 @node Formatting the file names
8554 @subsection Formatting the file names
8556 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
8562 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
8565 @opindex --quoting-style
8566 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
8567 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
8568 backslash sequences like those used in C.
8572 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
8575 @opindex --quoting-style
8576 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
8577 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
8578 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
8582 @itemx --hide-control-chars
8584 @opindex --hide-control-chars
8585 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
8586 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
8591 @itemx --quoting-style=c
8593 @opindex --quote-name
8594 @opindex --quoting-style
8595 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
8598 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
8599 @opindex --quoting-style
8600 @cindex quoting style
8601 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
8602 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
8603 be one of the following:
8605 @macro quotingStyles
8608 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{--literal} (@option{-N})
8611 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
8612 cause ambiguous output.
8613 The quoting is suitable for POSIX-compatible shells like
8614 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
8617 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
8619 Like @samp{shell}, but also quoting non-printable characters using the POSIX
8620 proposed @samp{$''} syntax suitable for most shells.
8621 @item shell-escape-always
8622 Like @samp{shell-escape}, but quote strings even if they would
8623 normally not require quoting.
8625 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
8626 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
8627 @option{--quote-name} (@option{-Q}) option.
8629 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
8630 surrounding double-quote
8631 characters; this is the same as the @option{--escape} (@option{-b}) option.
8633 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
8634 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
8637 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
8638 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
8639 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
8640 @t{'like this'} instead of @t{"like
8641 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
8646 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
8647 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment
8648 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{shell-escape} when the
8649 output is a terminal, and @samp{literal} otherwise.
8651 @item --show-control-chars
8652 @opindex --show-control-chars
8653 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
8654 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
8660 @node dir invocation
8661 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
8664 @cindex directory listing, brief
8666 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
8667 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
8668 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
8670 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
8673 @node vdir invocation
8674 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
8677 @cindex directory listing, verbose
8679 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
8680 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
8681 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
8683 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
8685 @node dircolors invocation
8686 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
8690 @cindex setup for color
8692 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
8693 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
8697 eval "$(dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}])"
8700 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
8701 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
8702 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
8703 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
8705 To make @command{dircolors} read a @file{~/.dircolors} file if it
8706 exists, you can put the following lines in your @file{~/.bashrc} (or
8707 adapt them to your favorite shell):
8711 test -r $d && eval "$(dircolors $d)"
8715 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
8716 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
8717 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
8718 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
8719 environment variable.
8721 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8726 @itemx --bourne-shell
8729 @opindex --bourne-shell
8730 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
8731 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
8732 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
8733 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
8742 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
8743 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
8744 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
8745 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
8748 @itemx --print-database
8750 @opindex --print-database
8751 @cindex color database, printing
8752 @cindex database for color setup, printing
8753 @cindex printing color database
8754 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
8755 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
8756 of the possibilities.
8758 @item --print-ls-colors
8759 @opindex --print-ls-colors
8760 @cindex printing ls colors
8761 Print the LS_COLORS entries on separate lines,
8762 each colored as per the color they represent.
8769 @node Basic operations
8770 @chapter Basic operations
8772 @cindex manipulating files
8774 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
8775 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
8778 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
8779 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
8780 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
8781 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
8782 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
8783 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
8788 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
8791 @cindex copying files and directories
8792 @cindex files, copying
8793 @cindex directories, copying
8795 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
8796 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
8797 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
8801 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
8802 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
8803 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
8808 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
8812 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8813 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8814 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8815 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
8816 using the @var{source}s' names.
8819 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
8820 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
8822 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
8823 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
8824 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
8825 to corresponding destination directories.
8827 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
8828 link only when not copying recursively or when @option{--link}
8829 (@option{-l}) is used. This default can be overridden with the
8830 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
8831 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
8832 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
8833 the last one silently overrides the others.
8835 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} follows the
8836 link only when it refers to an existing regular file.
8837 However, when copying to a dangling symbolic link, @command{cp}
8838 refuses by default, and fails with a diagnostic, since the operation
8839 is inherently dangerous. This behavior is contrary to historical
8840 practice and to POSIX@.
8841 Set @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} to make @command{cp} attempt to create
8842 the target of a dangling destination symlink, in spite of the possible risk.
8843 Also, when an option like
8844 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
8845 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
8846 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
8848 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
8849 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
8850 @option{--copy-contents} option.
8852 @cindex self-backups
8853 @cindex backups, making only
8854 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
8855 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
8856 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
8857 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
8858 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
8859 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
8861 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8868 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
8869 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
8870 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
8871 directory in a different order).
8872 Try to preserve SELinux security context and extended attributes (xattr),
8873 but ignore any failure to do that and print no corresponding diagnostic.
8874 Equivalent to @option{-dR --preserve=all} with the reduced diagnostics.
8876 @item --attributes-only
8877 @opindex --attributes-only
8878 Copy only the specified attributes of the source file to the destination.
8879 If the destination already exists, do not alter its contents.
8880 See the @option{--preserve} option for controlling which attributes to copy.
8883 @itemx --backup[=@var{method}]
8886 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
8887 @cindex backups, making
8888 @xref{Backup options}.
8889 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
8890 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
8891 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
8892 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
8893 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
8897 # Usage: backup FILE...
8898 # Create a GNU-style backup of each listed FILE.
8901 cp --backup --force --preserve=all -- "$i" "$i" || fail=1
8906 @item --copy-contents
8907 @cindex directories, copying recursively
8908 @cindex copying directories recursively
8909 @cindex recursively copying directories
8910 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
8911 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
8912 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
8913 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
8914 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
8915 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
8916 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
8917 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
8918 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
8919 fill up your destination file system if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
8920 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
8921 affect the copying of symbolic links.
8925 @cindex symbolic links, copying
8926 @cindex hard links, preserving
8927 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
8928 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
8929 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
8934 @cindex debugging, copying
8935 Print extra information to stdout, explaining how files are copied.
8936 This option implies the @option{--verbose} option.
8944 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
8945 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force},
8946 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then
8947 tries to recreate the file by first removing it. Note @option{--force}
8948 alone will not remove dangling symlinks.
8949 When this option is combined with
8950 @option{--link} (@option{-l}) or @option{--symbolic-link}
8951 (@option{-s}), the destination link is replaced, and unless
8952 @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) is also given there is no brief
8953 moment when the destination does not exist. Also see the
8954 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
8956 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
8957 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
8959 This option is ignored when the @option{--no-clobber} or @option{-n} option
8964 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
8965 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
8966 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
8967 via recursive traversal.
8970 @itemx --interactive
8972 @opindex --interactive
8973 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
8974 overwrite an existing destination file, and fail if the response
8975 is not affirmative. The @option{-i} option overrides
8976 a previous @option{-n} option.
8982 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
8985 @itemx --dereference
8987 @opindex --dereference
8988 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
8989 With this option, @command{cp} cannot create a symbolic link.
8990 For example, a symlink (to regular file) in the source tree will be copied to
8991 a regular file in the destination tree.
8996 @opindex --no-clobber
8997 Do not overwrite an existing file; silently fail instead.
8998 This option overrides a previous
8999 @option{-i} option. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or
9000 @option{--backup} option.
9003 @itemx --no-dereference
9005 @opindex --no-dereference
9006 @cindex symbolic links, copying
9007 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
9008 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
9009 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
9012 @itemx --preserve[=@var{attribute_list}]
9015 @cindex file information, preserving, extended attributes, xattr
9016 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
9017 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
9018 of one or more of the following strings:
9022 @cindex access control lists (ACLs)
9023 Preserve attributes relevant to access permissions,
9024 including file mode bits and (if possible) access control lists (ACLs).
9025 ACL preservation is system-dependent, and ACLs are not necessarily
9026 translated when the source and destination are on file systems with
9027 different ACL formats (e.g., NFSv4 versus POSIX formats).
9030 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
9031 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
9033 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
9034 a member of the desired group.
9036 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
9037 On older systems, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
9038 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
9039 However, many systems now provide the @code{utimensat} function,
9040 which makes it possible even for symbolic links.
9042 Preserve in the destination files
9043 any links between corresponding source files.
9044 Note that with @option{-L} or @option{-H}, this option can convert
9045 symbolic links to hard links. For example,
9047 $ mkdir c; : > a; ln -s a b; cp -aH a b c; ls -i1 c
9052 Note the inputs: @file{b} is a symlink to regular file @file{a},
9053 yet the files in destination directory, @file{c/}, are hard-linked.
9054 Since @option{-a} implies @option{--no-dereference} it would copy the symlink,
9055 but the later @option{-H} tells @command{cp} to dereference the command line
9056 arguments where it then sees two files with the same inode number.
9057 Then the @option{--preserve=links} option also implied by @option{-a}
9058 will preserve the perceived hard link.
9060 Here is a similar example that exercises @command{cp}'s @option{-L} option:
9062 $ mkdir b c; (cd b; : > a; ln -s a b); cp -aL b c; ls -i1 c/b
9068 Preserve SELinux security context of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
9070 @cindex access control lists (ACLs)
9071 Preserve extended attributes of the file, or fail with full diagnostics.
9072 If @command{cp} is built without xattr support, ignore this option.
9073 If SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities are implemented using xattrs,
9074 they are preserved implicitly by this option as well, i.e., even without
9075 specifying @option{--preserve=mode} or @option{--preserve=context}.
9077 Preserve all file attributes.
9078 Equivalent to specifying all of the above, but with the difference
9079 that failure to preserve SELinux security context or extended attributes
9080 does not change @command{cp}'s exit status. In contrast to @option{-a},
9081 all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
9084 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
9085 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
9087 In the absence of this option, the permissions of existing destination
9088 files are unchanged. Each new file is created with the mode of the
9089 corresponding source file minus the set-user-ID, set-group-ID, and
9090 sticky bits as the create mode; the operating system then applies either
9091 the umask or a default ACL, possibly resulting in a more restrictive
9093 @xref{File permissions}.
9095 @item --no-preserve=@var{attribute_list}
9096 @cindex file information, preserving
9097 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
9098 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
9102 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
9103 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
9104 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
9105 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
9106 For example, the command:
9109 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
9113 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
9114 any missing intermediate directories.
9121 @opindex --recursive
9122 @cindex directories, copying recursively
9123 @cindex copying directories recursively
9124 @cindex recursively copying directories
9125 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
9126 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
9127 links in the source unless used together with the @option{--link}
9128 (@option{-l}) option; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
9129 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
9130 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
9131 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
9132 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
9133 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
9134 non-GNU systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
9135 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
9136 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
9137 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as POSIX allows
9138 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
9140 @item --reflink[=@var{when}]
9141 @opindex --reflink[=@var{when}]
9144 @cindex copy on write
9145 Perform a lightweight, copy-on-write (COW) copy, if supported by the
9146 file system. Once it has succeeded, beware that the source and destination
9147 files share the same data blocks as long as they remain unmodified.
9148 Thus, if an I/O error affects data blocks of one of the files,
9149 the other suffers the same fate.
9151 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
9155 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported
9156 then report the failure for each file and exit with a failure status.
9157 Plain @option{--reflink} is equivalent to @option{--reflink=always}.
9160 If the copy-on-write operation is not supported then fall back
9161 to the standard copy behavior.
9162 This is the default if no @option{--reflink} option is given.
9165 Disable copy-on-write operation and use the standard copy behavior.
9168 This option is overridden by the @option{--link}, @option{--symbolic-link}
9169 and @option{--attributes-only} options, thus allowing it to be used
9170 to configure the default data copying behavior for @command{cp}.
9172 @item --remove-destination
9173 @opindex --remove-destination
9174 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
9175 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
9177 @item --sparse=@var{when}
9178 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
9179 @cindex sparse files, copying
9180 @cindex holes, copying files with
9181 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
9182 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes} -- a sequence of zero bytes that
9183 does not occupy any file system blocks; the @samp{read} system call
9184 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable space and
9185 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
9186 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
9187 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
9188 Only regular files may be sparse.
9190 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
9194 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
9195 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
9196 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
9199 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
9200 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
9201 input file does not appear to be sparse.
9202 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
9203 that does not support sparse files
9204 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
9205 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
9206 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
9207 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
9210 Never make the output file sparse.
9211 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
9212 since such a file must not have any holes.
9215 For example, with the following alias, @command{cp} will use the
9216 minimum amount of space supported by the file system.
9217 (Older versions of @command{cp} can also benefit from
9218 @option{--reflink=auto} here.)
9221 alias cp='cp --sparse=always'
9224 @optStripTrailingSlashes
9227 @itemx --symbolic-link
9229 @opindex --symbolic-link
9230 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
9231 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
9232 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
9233 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
9234 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
9240 @optNoTargetDirectory
9243 @itemx --update[=@var{which}]
9245 @opindex --update[=@var{which}]
9246 @cindex newer files, copying only
9247 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
9248 same or newer modification timestamp; instead, silently skip the file
9249 without failing. If timestamps are being preserved,
9250 the comparison is to the source timestamp truncated to the
9251 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
9252 used to update timestamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
9253 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and destination.
9254 This option is ignored if the @option{-n} or @option{--no-clobber}
9255 option is also specified.
9256 Also, if @option{--preserve=links} is also specified (like with @samp{cp -au}
9257 for example), that will take precedence; consequently, depending on the
9258 order that files are processed from the source, newer files in the destination
9259 may be replaced, to mirror hard links in the source.
9262 @var{which} gives more control over which existing files in the
9263 destination are replaced, and its value can be one of the following:
9267 This is the default operation when an @option{--update} option is not specified,
9268 and results in all existing files in the destination being replaced.
9271 This is similar to the @option{--no-clobber} option, in that no files in the
9272 destination are replaced, but also skipping a file does not induce a failure.
9275 This is the default operation when @option{--update} is specified, and results
9276 in files being replaced if they're older than the corresponding source file.
9285 Print the name of each file before copying it.
9288 @itemx --one-file-system
9290 @opindex --one-file-system
9291 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
9292 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
9293 the copy started on.
9294 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
9298 @itemx --context[=@var{context}]
9301 @cindex SELinux, setting/restoring security context
9302 @cindex security context
9303 Without a specified @var{context}, adjust the SELinux security context according
9304 to the system default type for destination files, similarly to the
9305 @command{restorecon} command.
9306 The long form of this option with a specific context specified,
9307 will set the context for newly created files only.
9308 With a specified context, if both SELinux and SMACK are disabled, a warning is
9312 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve=context}
9313 option, and overrides the @option{--preserve=all} and @option{-a} options.
9321 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
9324 @cindex converting while copying a file
9326 @command{dd} copies input to output with a changeable I/O block size,
9327 while optionally performing conversions on the data. Synopses:
9330 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
9334 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
9335 @xref{Common options}.
9337 By default, @command{dd} copies standard input to standard output.
9338 To copy, @command{dd} repeatedly does the following steps in order:
9342 Read an input block.
9345 If converting via @samp{sync}, pad as needed to meet the input block size.
9346 Pad with spaces if converting via @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, NUL
9350 If @samp{bs=} is given and no conversion mentioned in steps (4) or (5)
9351 is given, output the data as a single block and skip all remaining steps.
9354 If the @samp{swab} conversion is given, swap each pair of input bytes.
9355 If the input data length is odd, preserve the last input byte
9356 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
9359 If any of the conversions @samp{swab}, @samp{block}, @samp{unblock},
9360 @samp{lcase}, @samp{ucase}, @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic} and @samp{ibm}
9361 are given, do these conversions. These conversions operate
9362 independently of input blocking, and might deal with records that span
9366 Aggregate the resulting data into output blocks of the specified size,
9367 and output each output block in turn. Do not pad the last output block;
9368 it can be shorter than usual.
9371 @command{dd} accepts the following operands,
9372 whose syntax was inspired by the DD (data definition) statement of
9379 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
9383 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
9384 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, truncate @var{file} before writing it.
9386 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
9388 @cindex block size of input
9389 @cindex input block size
9390 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
9391 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
9392 The default is 512 bytes.
9394 @item obs=@var{bytes}
9396 @cindex block size of output
9397 @cindex output block size
9398 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
9399 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
9400 The default is 512 bytes.
9402 @item bs=@var{bytes}
9405 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
9406 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
9407 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
9408 In addition, if no data-transforming @option{conv} operand is specified,
9409 input is copied to the output as soon as it's read,
9410 even if it is smaller than the block size.
9412 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
9414 @cindex block size of conversion
9415 @cindex conversion block size
9416 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
9417 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
9418 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
9419 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
9420 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
9421 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
9424 @itemx iseek=@var{n}
9427 Skip @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
9428 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B}, interpret @var{n}
9429 as a byte count rather than a block count.
9430 (@samp{B} and the @samp{iseek=} spelling are GNU extensions to POSIX.)
9433 @itemx oseek=@var{n}
9436 Skip @var{n} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before
9437 truncating or copying.
9438 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B}, interpret @var{n}
9439 as a byte count rather than a block count.
9440 (@samp{B} and the @samp{oseek=} spelling are GNU extensions to POSIX.)
9444 Copy @var{n} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
9445 of everything until the end of the file.
9446 If @var{n} ends in the letter @samp{B},
9447 interpret @var{n} as a byte count rather than a block count;
9448 this is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9449 If short reads occur, as could be the case
9450 when reading from a pipe for example, @samp{iflag=fullblock}
9451 ensures that @samp{count=} counts complete input blocks
9452 rather than input read operations.
9453 As an extension to POSIX, @samp{count=0} copies zero blocks
9454 instead of copying all blocks.
9456 @item status=@var{level}
9458 Specify the amount of information printed.
9459 If this operand is given multiple times, the last one takes precedence.
9460 The @var{level} value can be one of the following:
9465 @opindex none @r{dd status=}
9466 Do not print any informational or warning messages to standard error.
9467 Error messages are output as normal.
9470 @opindex noxfer @r{dd status=}
9471 Do not print the final transfer rate and volume statistics
9472 that normally make up the last status line.
9475 @opindex progress @r{dd status=}
9476 Print the transfer rate and volume statistics on standard error,
9477 when processing each input block. Statistics are output
9478 on a single line at most once every second, but updates
9479 can be delayed when waiting on I/O.
9483 Transfer information is normally output to standard error upon
9484 receipt of the @samp{INFO} signal or when @command{dd} exits,
9485 and defaults to the following form in the C locale:
9489 116608+0 records out
9490 59703296 bytes (60 MB, 57 MiB) copied, 0.0427974 s, 1.4 GB/s
9493 The notation @samp{@var{w}+@var{p}} stands for @var{w} whole blocks
9494 and @var{p} partial blocks. A partial block occurs when a read or
9495 write operation succeeds but transfers less data than the block size.
9496 An additional line like @samp{1 truncated record} or @samp{10
9497 truncated records} is output after the @samp{records out} line if
9498 @samp{conv=block} processing truncated one or more input records.
9500 The @samp{status=} operand is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9502 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
9504 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
9505 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9512 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
9513 Convert EBCDIC to ASCII,
9514 using the conversion table specified by POSIX@.
9515 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
9516 This implies @samp{conv=unblock}; input is converted to
9517 ASCII before trailing spaces are deleted.
9520 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
9521 Convert ASCII to EBCDIC@.
9522 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
9523 This implies @samp{conv=block}; trailing spaces are added
9524 before being converted to EBCDIC@.
9527 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
9528 This acts like @samp{conv=ebcdic}, except it
9529 uses the alternate conversion table specified by POSIX@.
9530 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
9531 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
9533 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
9534 mutually exclusive. If you use any of these conversions, you should also
9535 use the @samp{cbs=} operand.
9538 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
9539 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
9540 input newline with a space and truncating or padding input lines with
9541 spaces as necessary.
9545 Remove any trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block,
9546 and append a newline.
9548 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
9549 If you use either of these conversions, you should also use the
9550 @samp{cbs=} operand.
9553 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
9554 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
9557 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
9558 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
9560 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
9564 Try to seek rather than write NUL output blocks.
9565 On a file system that supports sparse files, this will create
9566 sparse output when extending the output file.
9567 Be careful when using this conversion in conjunction with
9568 @samp{conv=notrunc} or @samp{oflag=append}.
9569 With @samp{conv=notrunc}, existing data in the output file
9570 corresponding to NUL blocks from the input, will be untouched.
9571 With @samp{oflag=append} the seeks performed will be ineffective.
9572 Similarly, when the output is a device rather than a file,
9573 NUL input blocks are not copied, and therefore this conversion
9574 is most useful with virtual or pre zeroed devices.
9576 The @samp{sparse} conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9579 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
9580 @cindex byte-swapping
9581 Swap every pair of input bytes.
9584 @opindex sync @r{(padding with ASCII NULs)}
9585 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
9586 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
9591 The following ``conversions'' are really file flags
9592 and don't affect internal processing:
9597 @cindex creating output file, requiring
9598 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
9603 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
9604 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
9606 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive,
9607 and are GNU extensions to POSIX.
9611 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
9612 Do not truncate the output file.
9616 @cindex read errors, ignoring
9617 Continue after read errors.
9621 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
9622 Synchronize output data just before finishing,
9623 even if there were write errors.
9624 This forces a physical write of output data,
9625 so that even if power is lost the output data will be preserved.
9626 If neither this nor @samp{fsync} are specified, output is treated as
9627 usual with file systems, i.e., output data and metadata may be cached
9628 in primary memory for some time before the operating system physically
9629 writes it, and thus output data and metadata may be lost if power is lost.
9630 @xref{sync invocation}.
9631 This conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9635 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
9636 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing,
9637 even if there were write errors.
9638 This acts like @samp{fdatasync} except it also preserves output metadata,
9639 such as the last-modified time of the output file; for this reason it
9640 may be a bit slower than @samp{fdatasync} although the performance
9641 difference is typically insignificant for @command{dd}.
9642 This conversion is a GNU extension to POSIX.
9646 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
9648 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
9649 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9651 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
9653 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
9654 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
9662 @cindex appending to the output file
9663 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
9664 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
9665 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
9666 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
9667 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
9668 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
9672 @cindex concurrent I/O
9673 Use concurrent I/O mode for data. This mode performs direct I/O
9674 and drops the POSIX requirement to serialize all I/O to the same file.
9675 A file cannot be opened in CIO mode and with a standard open at the
9681 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
9682 Note that the kernel may impose restrictions on read or write buffer sizes.
9683 For example, with an ext4 destination file system and a Linux-based kernel,
9684 using @samp{oflag=direct} will cause writes to fail with @code{EINVAL} if the
9685 output buffer size is not a multiple of 512.
9689 @cindex directory I/O
9691 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
9692 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
9696 @cindex synchronized data reads
9697 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
9698 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
9699 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
9700 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
9701 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
9705 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
9706 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
9710 @cindex discarding file cache
9711 Request to discard the system data cache for a file.
9712 When count=0 all cached data for the file is specified,
9713 otherwise the cache is dropped for the processed
9714 portion of the file. Also when count=0,
9715 failure to discard the cache is diagnosed
9716 and reflected in the exit status.
9718 Note data that is not already persisted to storage will not
9719 be discarded from cache, so note the use of the @samp{sync} conversions
9720 in the examples below, which are used to maximize the
9721 effectiveness of the @samp{nocache} flag.
9723 Here are some usage examples:
9726 # Advise to drop cache for whole file
9727 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache count=0
9729 # Ensure drop cache for the whole file
9730 dd of=ofile oflag=nocache conv=notrunc,fdatasync count=0
9732 # Advise to drop cache for part of file
9733 # Note the kernel will only consider complete and
9734 # already persisted pages.
9735 dd if=ifile iflag=nocache skip=10 count=10 of=/dev/null
9737 # Stream data using just the read-ahead cache.
9738 # See also the @samp{direct} flag.
9739 dd if=ifile of=ofile iflag=nocache oflag=nocache,sync
9744 @cindex nonblocking I/O
9745 Use non-blocking I/O.
9749 @cindex access timestamp
9750 Do not update the file's access timestamp.
9751 @xref{File timestamps}.
9752 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
9753 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
9757 @cindex controlling terminal
9758 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
9759 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
9760 On many hosts (e.g., GNU/Linux hosts), this flag has no effect
9765 @cindex symbolic links, following
9766 Do not follow symbolic links.
9771 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
9776 Use binary I/O@. This flag has an effect only on nonstandard
9777 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
9782 Use text I/O@. Like @samp{binary}, this flag has no effect on
9787 Accumulate full blocks from input. The @code{read} system call
9788 may return early if a full block is not available.
9789 When that happens, continue calling @code{read} to fill the remainder
9791 This flag can be used only with @code{iflag}.
9792 This flag is useful with pipes for example
9793 as they may return short reads. In that case,
9794 this flag is needed to ensure that a @samp{count=} argument is
9795 interpreted as a block count rather than a count of read operations.
9799 These flags are all GNU extensions to POSIX.
9800 They are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
9801 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
9802 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
9803 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
9804 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
9805 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
9809 The behavior of @command{dd} is unspecified if operands other than
9810 @samp{conv=}, @samp{iflag=}, @samp{oflag=}, and @samp{status=} are
9811 specified more than once.
9813 @cindex multipliers after numbers
9814 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{n} and @var{bytes})
9815 are unsigned decimal integers that
9816 can be followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
9817 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
9818 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
9819 These multipliers are GNU extensions to POSIX, except that
9820 POSIX allows @var{bytes} to be followed by @samp{k}, @samp{b}, and
9822 Block sizes (i.e., specified by @var{bytes} strings) must be nonzero.
9824 Any block size you specify via @samp{bs=}, @samp{ibs=}, @samp{obs=}, @samp{cbs=}
9825 should not be too large -- values larger than a few megabytes
9826 are generally wasteful or (as in the gigabyte..exabyte case) downright
9827 counterproductive or error-inducing.
9829 To process data with offset or size that is not a multiple of the I/O
9830 block size, you can use a numeric string @var{n} that ends in the
9832 For example, the following shell commands copy data
9833 in 1 MiB blocks between a flash drive and a tape, but do not save
9834 or restore a 512-byte area at the start of the flash drive:
9840 # Copy all but the initial 512 bytes from flash to tape.
9841 dd if=$flash iseek=512B bs=1MiB of=$tape
9843 # Copy from tape back to flash, leaving initial 512 bytes alone.
9844 dd if=$tape bs=1MiB of=$flash oseek=512B
9848 @cindex storage devices, failing
9849 For failing storage devices, other tools come with a great variety of extra
9850 functionality to ease the saving of as much data as possible before the
9851 device finally dies, e.g.
9852 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/ddrescue/, GNU @command{ddrescue}}.
9853 However, in some cases such a tool is not available or the administrator
9854 feels more comfortable with the handling of @command{dd}.
9855 As a simple rescue method, call @command{dd} as shown in the following
9856 example: the operand @samp{conv=noerror,sync} is used to continue
9857 after read errors and to pad out bad reads with NULs, while
9858 @samp{iflag=fullblock} caters for short reads (which traditionally never
9859 occur on flash or similar devices):
9862 # Rescue data from an (unmounted!) partition of a failing device.
9863 dd conv=noerror,sync iflag=fullblock </dev/sda1 > /mnt/rescue.img
9866 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal (or @samp{USR1} signal where that is unavailable)
9867 to a running @command{dd} process makes it print I/O statistics to
9868 standard error and then resume copying. In the example below,
9869 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 5GB of data.
9870 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
9871 and when @command{dd} completes normally or is killed by the
9872 @code{SIGINT} signal, it outputs the final statistics.
9875 # Ignore the signal so we never inadvertently terminate the dd child.
9876 # Note this is not needed when SIGINFO is available.
9879 # Run dd with the fullblock iflag to avoid short reads
9880 # which can be triggered by reception of signals.
9881 dd iflag=fullblock if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=5000000 bs=1000 & pid=$!
9883 # Output stats every second.
9884 while kill -s USR1 $pid 2>/dev/null; do sleep 1; done
9887 The above script will output in the following format:
9890 3441325+0 records in
9891 3441325+0 records out
9892 3441325000 bytes (3.4 GB, 3.2 GiB) copied, 1.00036 s, 3.4 GB/s
9893 5000000+0 records in
9894 5000000+0 records out
9895 5000000000 bytes (5.0 GB, 4.7 GiB) copied, 1.44433 s, 3.5 GB/s
9898 The @samp{status=progress} operand periodically updates the last line
9899 of the transfer statistics above.
9901 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
9902 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
9903 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
9904 environment variable is set.
9909 @node install invocation
9910 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
9913 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
9915 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
9916 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
9919 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
9920 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
9921 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
9922 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
9927 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
9931 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
9932 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
9933 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
9934 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
9935 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
9938 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
9939 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
9940 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
9941 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
9942 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
9943 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
9946 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
9947 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
9948 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
9949 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
9950 files onto themselves.
9952 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
9953 @command{install} never preserves extended attributes (xattr).
9955 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9965 Compare content of source and destination files, and if there would be no
9966 change to the destination content, owner, group, permissions, and possibly
9967 SELinux context, then do not modify the destination at all.
9968 Note this option is best used in conjunction with @option{--user},
9969 @option{--group} and @option{--mode} options, lest @command{install}
9970 incorrectly determines the default attributes that installed files would have
9971 (as it doesn't consider setgid directories and POSIX default ACLs for example).
9972 This could result in redundant copies or attributes that are not reset to the
9977 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
9981 Create any missing parent directories of @var{dest},
9982 then copy @var{source} to @var{dest}.
9983 Explicitly specifying the @option{--target-directory=@var{dir}} will similarly
9984 ensure the presence of that hierarchy before copying @var{source} arguments.
9989 @opindex --directory
9990 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
9991 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
9992 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
9993 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
9994 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
9995 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
9999 @item -g @var{group}
10000 @itemx --group=@var{group}
10003 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
10004 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
10005 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
10006 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
10008 @item -m @var{mode}
10009 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
10012 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
10013 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
10014 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
10015 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
10016 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
10017 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s} -- read, write, and
10018 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
10019 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
10020 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
10021 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
10022 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
10024 @item -o @var{owner}
10025 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
10028 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
10029 @cindex appropriate privileges
10030 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
10031 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
10032 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
10033 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
10036 @item --preserve-context
10037 @opindex --preserve-context
10039 @cindex security context
10040 Preserve the SELinux security context of files and directories.
10041 Failure to preserve the context in all of the files or directories
10042 will result in an exit status of 1. If SELinux is disabled then
10043 print a warning and ignore the option.
10046 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
10048 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
10049 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
10050 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
10051 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
10052 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
10053 last modification timestamps are both set to the time of installation.
10054 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification timestamps
10055 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
10056 to when they were last installed.
10062 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
10063 @cindex stripping symbol table information
10064 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
10066 @item --strip-program=@var{program}
10067 @opindex --strip-program
10068 @cindex symbol table information, stripping, program
10069 Program used to strip binaries.
10073 @optTargetDirectory
10074 Also specifying the @option{-D} option will ensure the directory is present.
10076 @optNoTargetDirectory
10082 Print the name of each file before copying it.
10085 This option is mutually exclusive with the @option{--preserve-context} option.
10093 @node mv invocation
10094 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
10098 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
10101 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
10102 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
10103 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
10108 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
10112 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10113 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10114 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10115 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
10116 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
10119 To move a file, @command{mv} ordinarily simply renames it.
10120 However, if renaming does not work because the destination's file
10121 system differs, @command{mv} falls back on copying as if by @code{cp -a},
10122 then (assuming the copy succeeded) it removes the original.
10123 If the copy fails, then @command{mv} removes any partially created
10124 copy in the destination. If you were to copy three directories from
10125 one file system to another and the copy of the first
10126 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
10127 the destination file system and the second and third would be left on the
10128 original file system.
10130 @cindex extended attributes, xattr
10131 @command{mv} always tries to copy extended attributes (xattr), which may
10132 include SELinux context, ACLs or Capabilities.
10133 Upon failure all but @samp{Operation not supported} warnings are output.
10135 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
10136 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
10137 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
10138 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
10139 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
10140 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
10142 @emph{Warning}: Avoid specifying a source name with a trailing slash,
10143 when it might be a symlink to a directory.
10144 Otherwise, @command{mv} may do something very surprising, since
10145 its behavior depends on the underlying rename system call.
10146 On a system with a modern Linux-based kernel, it fails with
10147 @code{errno=ENOTDIR}@.
10148 However, on other systems (at least FreeBSD 6.1 and Solaris 10) it silently
10149 renames not the symlink but rather the directory referenced by the symlink.
10150 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
10152 @emph{Note}: @command{mv} will only replace empty directories in the
10153 destination. Conflicting populated directories are skipped with a diagnostic.
10155 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10167 @cindex prompts, omitting
10168 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
10170 If you specify more than one of the @option{-i}, @option{-f}, @option{-n}
10171 options, only the final one takes effect.
10176 @itemx --interactive
10178 @opindex --interactive
10179 @cindex prompts, forcing
10180 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
10181 of its permissions, and fail if the response is not affirmative.
10185 @itemx --no-clobber
10187 @opindex --no-clobber
10188 @cindex prompts, omitting
10189 Do not overwrite an existing file; silently fail instead.
10191 This option is mutually exclusive with @option{-b} or @option{--backup} option.
10192 See also the @option{--update=none} option which will
10193 skip existing files but not fail.
10197 @cindex renaming files without copying them
10198 If a file cannot be renamed because the destination file system differs,
10199 fail with a diagnostic instead of copying and then removing the file.
10205 @cindex newer files, moving only
10206 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
10207 same or newer modification timestamp;
10208 instead, silently skip the file without failing.
10209 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
10210 source timestamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
10211 system and of the system calls used to update timestamps; this avoids
10212 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
10213 same source and destination.
10214 This option is ignored if the @option{-n} or @option{--no-clobber}
10215 option is also specified.
10223 Print the name of each file before moving it.
10225 @optStripTrailingSlashes
10229 @optTargetDirectory
10231 @optNoTargetDirectory
10237 @cindex SELinux, restoring security context
10238 @cindex security context
10239 This option functions similarly to the @command{restorecon} command,
10240 by adjusting the SELinux security context according
10241 to the system default type for destination files and each created directory.
10248 @node rm invocation
10249 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
10252 @cindex removing files or directories
10254 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
10255 directories. Synopsis:
10258 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
10261 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
10262 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
10263 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
10264 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
10265 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
10266 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
10268 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
10269 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
10270 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
10271 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
10272 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
10274 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
10275 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting, as mandated
10278 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
10279 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
10280 that the contents are unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
10282 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10290 @cindex directories, removing
10291 Remove the listed directories if they are empty.
10297 Ignore nonexistent files and missing operands, and never prompt the user.
10298 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
10302 Prompt whether to remove each file.
10303 If the response is not affirmative, silently skip the file without failing.
10304 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
10305 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
10309 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
10310 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
10311 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
10312 @option{--interactive=once}.
10314 @item --interactive [=@var{when}]
10315 @opindex --interactive
10316 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
10317 omitted, or one of:
10320 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
10321 - Do not prompt at all.
10323 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
10324 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
10325 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
10327 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
10328 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
10330 @option{--interactive} with no @var{when} is equivalent to
10331 @option{--interactive=always}.
10333 @item --one-file-system
10334 @opindex --one-file-system
10335 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
10336 When removing a hierarchy recursively, do not remove any directory that is on a
10337 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
10339 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
10340 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
10341 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
10342 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
10343 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
10344 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
10345 under @file{/home}, too.
10346 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
10347 diagnose and skip directories on other file systems.
10348 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
10349 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
10350 See also @option{--preserve-root=all} to protect command line arguments
10353 @item --preserve-root [=all]
10354 @opindex --preserve-root
10355 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
10356 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
10357 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
10358 This is the default behavior.
10359 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10360 When @samp{all} is specified, reject any command line argument
10361 that is not on the same file system as its parent.
10363 @item --no-preserve-root
10364 @opindex --no-preserve-root
10365 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
10366 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
10367 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
10368 remove all the files on your computer.
10369 @xref{Treating / specially}.
10376 @opindex --recursive
10377 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
10378 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
10384 Print the name of each file before removing it.
10388 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
10389 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
10390 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
10391 @samp{-}. GNU @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
10392 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
10393 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
10394 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
10407 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
10408 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
10409 predates the development of the @code{getopt} standard syntax.
10414 @node shred invocation
10415 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
10418 @cindex data, erasing
10419 @cindex erasing data
10421 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
10422 extensive forensics from recovering the data.
10424 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), its data
10425 and metadata are not actually destroyed. Only the file's directory
10426 entry is removed, and the file's storage is reclaimed only when no
10427 process has the file open and no other directory entry links to the
10428 file. And even if file's data and metadata's storage space is freed
10429 for further reuse, there are undelete utilities that will attempt to
10430 reconstruct the file from the data in freed storage, and that can
10431 bring the file back if the storage was not rewritten.
10433 On a busy system with a nearly-full device, space can get reused in a few
10434 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. And although the
10435 undelete utilities and already-existing processes require insider or
10436 superuser access, you may be wary of the superuser,
10437 of processes running on your behalf, or of attackers
10438 that can physically access the storage device. So if you have sensitive
10439 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible
10440 by plausible attacks like these.
10442 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
10443 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
10444 this is often the preferred method. However, some storage devices
10445 are expensive or are harder to destroy, so the @command{shred} utility tries
10446 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively, by overwriting the file
10447 with non-sensitive data.
10449 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a crucial
10450 assumption: that the file system and hardware overwrite data in place.
10451 Although this is common and is the traditional
10452 way to do things, many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
10453 assumption. Exceptions include:
10458 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as ext3/ext4 (in
10459 @code{data=journal} mode), Btrfs, NTFS, ReiserFS, XFS, ZFS, file
10460 systems supplied with AIX and Solaris, etc., when they are configured to
10464 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
10465 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
10468 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
10471 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
10475 Compressed file systems.
10478 For ext3 and ext4 file systems, @command{shred} is less effective
10479 when the file system is in @code{data=journal}
10480 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
10481 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
10482 @command{shred} works as usual. The ext3/ext4 journaling modes can be changed
10483 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
10484 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
10485 the @command{mount} man page (@samp{man mount}). Alternatively, if
10486 you know how large the journal is, you can shred the journal by
10487 shredding enough file data so that the journal cycles around and fills
10488 up with shredded data.
10490 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
10491 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means @command{shred} cannot
10492 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
10494 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
10495 since this bypasses file system design issues mentioned above.
10496 However, devices are also problematic for shredding, for reasons
10497 such as the following:
10502 Solid-state storage devices (SSDs) typically do wear leveling to
10503 prolong service life, and this means writes are distributed to other
10504 blocks by the hardware, so ``overwritten'' data blocks are still
10505 present in the underlying device.
10508 Most storage devices map out bad blocks invisibly to
10509 the application; if the bad blocks contain sensitive data,
10510 @command{shred} won't be able to destroy it.
10513 With some obsolete storage technologies,
10514 it may be possible to take (say) a floppy disk back
10515 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
10516 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
10517 overwritten data. With these older technologies, if the file has been
10518 overwritten only once, it's reputedly not even that hard. Luckily,
10519 this kind of data recovery has become difficult, and there is no
10520 public evidence that today's higher-density storage devices can be
10521 analyzed in this way.
10523 The @command{shred} command can use many overwrite passes,
10524 with data patterns chosen to
10525 maximize the damage they do to the old data.
10526 By default the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives using
10527 now-obsolete technology; for newer devices, a single pass should suffice.
10528 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
10529 @uref{https://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
10530 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
10531 from the proceedings of the Sixth USENIX Security Symposium (San Jose,
10532 California, July 22--25, 1996).
10535 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report these problems, just as
10536 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
10537 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
10538 not deallocate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
10539 for devices, which typically cannot be deallocated and should not be
10542 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
10543 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
10544 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
10545 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
10546 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
10549 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
10552 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10560 @cindex force deletion
10561 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
10563 @item -n @var{number}
10564 @itemx --iterations=@var{number}
10565 @opindex -n @var{number}
10566 @opindex --iterations=@var{number}
10567 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
10568 By default, @command{shred} uses @value{SHRED_DEFAULT_PASSES} passes of
10569 overwrite. You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you think it's
10570 appropriate. After 25 passes all of the internal overwrite patterns will have
10571 been used at least once.
10573 @item --random-source=@var{file}
10574 @opindex --random-source
10575 @cindex random source for shredding
10576 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
10577 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
10579 @item -s @var{bytes}
10580 @itemx --size=@var{bytes}
10581 @opindex -s @var{bytes}
10582 @opindex --size=@var{bytes}
10583 @cindex size of file to shred
10584 Shred the first @var{bytes} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
10585 the whole file. @var{bytes} can be followed by a size specification like
10586 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
10589 @itemx --remove[=@var{how}]
10592 @opindex --remove=unlink
10593 @opindex --remove=wipe
10594 @opindex --remove=wipesync
10595 @cindex removing files after shredding
10596 After shredding a file, deallocate it (if possible) and then remove it.
10597 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
10598 Often the file name is less sensitive than the file data, in which case
10599 the optional @var{how} parameter, supported with the long form option,
10600 gives control of how to more efficiently remove each directory entry.
10601 The @samp{unlink} parameter will just use a standard unlink call,
10602 @samp{wipe} will also first obfuscate bytes in the name, and
10603 @samp{wipesync} will also sync each obfuscated byte in the name to
10605 Note @samp{wipesync} is the default method, but can be expensive,
10606 requiring a sync for every character in every file. This can become
10607 significant with many files, or is redundant if your file system provides
10608 synchronous metadata updates.
10614 Display to standard error all status updates as sterilization proceeds.
10620 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
10621 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the slack space in
10622 the last block of the file. This space may contain portions of the current
10623 system memory on some systems for example.
10624 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
10625 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
10626 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
10627 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
10633 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
10634 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your storage device (for
10635 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
10636 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
10637 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
10638 by the @option{--iterations} option.
10642 You might use the following command to erase the file system you
10643 created on a USB flash drive. This command typically takes several
10644 minutes, depending on the drive's size and write speed. On modern
10645 storage devices a single pass should be adequate, and will take one
10646 third the time of the default three-pass approach.
10649 shred -v -n 1 /dev/sdd1
10652 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
10653 your device, you could give a command like the following.
10656 # 1 pass, write pseudo-random data; 3x faster than the default
10657 shred -v -n1 /dev/sda5
10660 To be on the safe side, use at least one pass that overwrites using
10661 pseudo-random data. I.e., don't be tempted to use @samp{-n0 --zero},
10662 in case some device controller optimizes the process of writing blocks
10663 of all zeros, and thereby does not clear all bytes in a block.
10664 Some SSDs may do just that.
10666 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
10667 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
10674 echo "Hello, world" >&3
10679 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
10680 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
10681 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
10682 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
10687 @node Special file types
10688 @chapter Special file types
10690 @cindex special file types
10691 @cindex file types, special
10693 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
10694 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
10696 @cindex special file types
10698 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
10699 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
10700 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
10701 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
10702 which it does in a @dfn{directory} -- a special type of file. Although
10703 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
10704 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
10705 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
10707 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
10708 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
10711 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
10712 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
10713 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
10714 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
10715 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
10716 * readlink invocation:: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name.
10717 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
10718 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
10722 @node link invocation
10723 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
10726 @cindex links, creating
10727 @cindex hard links, creating
10728 @cindex creating links (hard only)
10730 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
10731 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
10732 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
10733 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10734 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
10735 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
10739 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
10742 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
10743 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
10744 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
10745 to create the link.
10747 On a GNU system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
10748 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
10749 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
10750 not specified by POSIX, and the @command{link} command is
10751 more portable in practice.
10753 If @var{filename} is a symbolic link, it is unspecified whether
10754 @var{linkname} will be a hard link to the symbolic link or to the
10755 target of the symbolic link. Use @command{ln -P} or @command{ln -L}
10756 to specify which behavior is desired.
10761 @node ln invocation
10762 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
10765 @cindex links, creating
10766 @cindex hard links, creating
10767 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
10768 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
10770 @cindex file systems and hard links
10771 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
10772 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
10776 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
10777 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
10778 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
10779 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
10785 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
10786 file from the second.
10789 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
10790 in the current directory.
10793 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
10794 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
10795 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
10796 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
10797 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
10801 Normally @command{ln} does not replace existing files. Use the
10802 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to replace them unconditionally,
10803 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to replace them
10804 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
10805 rename them. Unless the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option is
10806 used there is no brief moment when the destination does not exist;
10807 this is an extension to POSIX.
10809 @cindex hard link, defined
10810 @cindex inode, and hard links
10811 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
10812 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
10813 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
10814 file -- indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
10815 file. Most systems prohibit making a hard link to
10816 a directory; on those where it is allowed, only the super-user can do
10817 so (and with caution, since creating a cycle will cause problems to many
10818 other utilities). Hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
10819 restrictions are not mandated by POSIX, however.)
10821 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
10822 @cindex symbolic link, defined
10823 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
10824 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
10825 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
10826 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
10827 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
10828 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
10829 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
10830 link file itself, rather than on its target. The owner and group of a
10831 symlink are not significant to file access performed through
10832 the link, but do have implications on deleting a symbolic link from a
10833 directory with the restricted deletion bit set. On the GNU system,
10834 the mode of a symlink has no significance and cannot be changed, but
10835 on some BSD systems, the mode can be changed and will affect whether
10836 the symlink will be traversed in file name resolution. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
10837 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
10839 Symbolic links can contain arbitrary strings; a @dfn{dangling symlink}
10840 occurs when the string in the symlink does not resolve to a file.
10841 There are no restrictions against creating dangling symbolic links.
10842 There are trade-offs to using absolute or relative symlinks. An
10843 absolute symlink always points to the same file, even if the directory
10844 containing the link is moved. However, if the symlink is visible from
10845 more than one machine (such as on a networked file system), the file
10846 pointed to might not always be the same. A relative symbolic link is
10847 resolved in relation to the directory that contains the link, and is
10848 often useful in referring to files on the same device without regards
10849 to what name that device is mounted on when accessed via networked
10852 When creating a relative symlink in a different location than the
10853 current directory, the resolution of the symlink will be different
10854 than the resolution of the same string from the current directory.
10855 Therefore, many users prefer to first change directories to the
10856 location where the relative symlink will be created, so that
10857 tab-completion or other file resolution will find the same target as
10858 what will be placed in the symlink.
10860 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10871 @opindex --directory
10872 @cindex hard links to directories
10873 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
10875 However, note that this will probably fail due to
10876 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
10882 Remove existing destination files.
10885 @itemx --interactive
10887 @opindex --interactive
10888 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
10889 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files,
10890 and fail if the response is not affirmative.
10896 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
10897 link, create the hard link to the file referred to by the symbolic
10898 link, rather than the symbolic link itself.
10901 @itemx --no-dereference
10903 @opindex --no-dereference
10904 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
10905 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
10907 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
10908 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
10909 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
10910 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
10911 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
10912 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
10913 non-directory -- as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
10914 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
10915 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
10916 just like a directory.
10918 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
10919 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
10924 @opindex --physical
10925 If @option{-s} is not in effect, and the source file is a symbolic
10926 link, create the hard link to the symbolic link itself. On platforms
10927 where this is not supported by the kernel, this option creates a
10928 symbolic link with identical contents; since symbolic link contents
10929 cannot be edited, any file name resolution performed through either
10930 link will be the same as if a hard link had been created.
10935 @opindex --relative
10936 Make symbolic links relative to the link location.
10937 This option is only valid with the @option{--symbolic} option.
10942 ln -srv /a/file /tmp
10943 '/tmp/file' -> '../a/file'
10946 Relative symbolic links are generated based on their canonicalized
10947 containing directory, and canonicalized targets. I.e., all symbolic
10948 links in these file names will be resolved.
10949 @xref{realpath invocation}, which gives greater control
10950 over relative file name generation, as demonstrated in the following example:
10955 test "$1" = --no-symlinks && { nosym=$1; shift; }
10957 test -d "$2" && link="$2/." || link="$2"
10958 rtarget="$(realpath $nosym -m "$target" \
10959 --relative-to "$(dirname "$link")")"
10960 ln -s -v "$rtarget" "$link"
10968 @opindex --symbolic
10969 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
10970 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
10974 @optTargetDirectory
10976 @optNoTargetDirectory
10982 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
10986 @cindex hard links to symbolic links
10987 @cindex symbolic links and @command{ln}
10988 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
10989 precedence. If @option{-s} is also given, @option{-L} and @option{-P}
10990 are silently ignored. If neither option is given, then this
10991 implementation defaults to @option{-P} if the system @code{link} supports
10992 hard links to symbolic links (such as the GNU system), and @option{-L}
10993 if @code{link} follows symbolic links (such as on BSD).
11002 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
11003 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
11008 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
11014 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
11015 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
11019 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
11020 # work across networked file systems.
11021 ln -s afile anotherfile
11022 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
11026 @node mkdir invocation
11027 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
11030 @cindex directories, creating
11031 @cindex creating directories
11033 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
11036 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11039 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
11040 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
11041 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
11043 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11047 @item -m @var{mode}
11048 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11051 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
11052 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
11053 which uses the same syntax as
11054 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
11055 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
11056 This option affects only directories given on the command line;
11057 it does not affect any parents that may be created via the @option{-p} option.
11059 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
11060 is created. As a GNU extension, @var{mode} may also mention
11061 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
11062 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
11063 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
11064 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
11065 overridden in this way.
11071 @cindex parent directories, creating
11072 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
11073 file permission bits to @samp{=rwx,u+wx},
11074 that is, with the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
11075 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
11078 If the @option{-m} option is also given, it does not affect
11079 file permission bits of any newly-created parent directories.
11080 To control these bits, set the
11081 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
11082 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
11083 @file{P} it sets the parent's file permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
11084 (The umask must include @samp{u=wx} for this method to work.)
11085 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
11086 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
11087 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
11088 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
11094 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
11095 @option{--parents}.
11104 @node mkfifo invocation
11105 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
11108 @cindex FIFOs, creating
11109 @cindex named pipes, creating
11110 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
11112 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
11113 specified names. Synopsis:
11116 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
11119 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
11120 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
11121 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
11122 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
11124 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11128 @item -m @var{mode}
11129 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11132 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
11133 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
11134 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
11135 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
11136 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
11145 @node mknod invocation
11146 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
11149 @cindex block special files, creating
11150 @cindex character special files, creating
11152 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
11153 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
11156 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
11159 @cindex special files
11160 @cindex block special files
11161 @cindex character special files
11162 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
11163 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
11164 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
11165 e.g., a printer or a flash drive. (These files are typically created at
11166 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
11167 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
11168 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
11169 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
11171 @c mknod is a shell built-in at least with OpenBSD's /bin/sh
11172 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{mknod}
11174 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
11179 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
11183 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
11184 for a block special file
11187 @c Don't document the 'u' option -- it's just a synonym for 'c'.
11188 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
11190 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
11191 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
11192 for a character special file
11196 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
11197 device numbers must be given after the file type.
11198 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
11199 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
11200 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
11202 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11206 @item -m @var{mode}
11207 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
11210 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
11211 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
11212 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
11213 @xref{File permissions}.
11222 @node readlink invocation
11223 @section @command{readlink}: Print value of a symlink or canonical file name
11226 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
11227 @cindex canonical file name
11228 @cindex canonicalize a file name
11231 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
11235 @item Readlink mode
11237 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic links.
11238 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
11239 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
11241 @item Canonicalize mode
11243 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given files which contain
11244 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
11245 (@file{/}) or symbolic links. Note the @command{realpath} command is the
11246 preferred command to use for canonicalization. @xref{realpath invocation}.
11251 readlink [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11254 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
11256 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11261 @itemx --canonicalize
11263 @opindex --canonicalize
11264 Activate canonicalize mode.
11265 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
11266 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit
11267 code. A trailing slash is ignored.
11270 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
11272 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
11273 Activate canonicalize mode.
11274 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
11275 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code. A trailing slash
11276 requires that the name resolve to a directory.
11279 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
11281 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
11282 Activate canonicalize mode.
11283 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
11287 @itemx --no-newline
11289 @opindex --no-newline
11290 Do not print the output delimiter, when a single @var{file} is specified.
11291 Print a warning if specified along with multiple @var{file}s.
11301 Suppress most error messages. On by default.
11307 Report error messages.
11313 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
11315 The @command{realpath} command without options, operates like
11316 @command{readlink} in canonicalize mode.
11321 @node rmdir invocation
11322 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
11325 @cindex removing empty directories
11326 @cindex directories, removing empty
11328 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
11331 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
11334 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
11335 directory, it is an error.
11337 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11341 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
11342 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
11343 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
11344 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is non-empty.
11350 @cindex parent directories, removing
11351 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
11352 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
11353 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
11354 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
11355 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
11356 exit unsuccessfully.
11362 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
11363 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
11364 @var{directory} is removed.
11368 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories recursively.
11370 To remove all empty directories under @var{dirname}, including
11371 directories that become empty because other directories are removed,
11372 you can use either of the following commands:
11375 # This uses GNU extensions.
11376 find @var{dirname} -type d -empty -delete
11378 # This runs on any POSIX platform.
11379 find @var{dirname} -depth -type d -exec rmdir @{@} +
11385 @node unlink invocation
11386 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
11389 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
11391 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
11392 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
11393 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
11394 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
11395 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
11396 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
11399 unlink @var{filename}
11402 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
11403 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
11404 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
11406 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
11407 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
11408 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
11413 @node Changing file attributes
11414 @chapter Changing file attributes
11416 @cindex changing file attributes
11417 @cindex file attributes, changing
11418 @cindex attributes, file
11420 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
11421 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
11422 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
11423 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
11424 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
11427 These commands change file attributes.
11430 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
11431 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
11432 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
11433 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
11437 @node chown invocation
11438 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
11441 @cindex file ownership, changing
11442 @cindex group ownership, changing
11443 @cindex changing file ownership
11444 @cindex changing group ownership
11446 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
11447 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
11451 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11455 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
11456 (with no embedded white space):
11459 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
11466 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
11467 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
11470 @item owner@samp{:}group
11471 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
11472 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
11473 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
11475 @item owner@samp{:}
11476 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
11477 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
11478 @var{owner}'s login group.
11480 @item @samp{:}group
11481 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
11482 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
11483 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
11486 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
11487 owner nor the group is changed.
11491 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
11492 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
11493 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
11495 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
11496 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
11497 require support for that, but for backward compatibility GNU
11498 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results,
11499 although it issues a warning and support may be removed in future versions.
11500 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
11501 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
11502 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
11505 @macro chownGroupRestrictions
11506 It is system dependent whether a user can change the group to an arbitrary one,
11507 or the more portable behavior of being restricted to setting a group of
11508 which the user is a member.
11510 @chownGroupRestrictions
11512 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
11513 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
11514 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
11515 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
11516 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
11517 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
11518 privileges, or when the
11519 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
11520 mandatory locking).
11521 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
11523 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11531 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
11532 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
11541 @cindex error messages, omitting
11542 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
11545 @item --from=@var{old-owner}
11547 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11548 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
11549 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
11551 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
11552 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
11553 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
11554 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
11557 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
11560 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
11561 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
11562 may be quite large.
11563 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
11567 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
11570 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
11571 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
11572 though still not perfect:
11575 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
11578 @item --dereference
11579 @opindex --dereference
11580 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11582 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
11583 This is the default when not operating recursively.
11584 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11587 @itemx --no-dereference
11589 @opindex --no-dereference
11590 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11592 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
11593 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
11594 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
11595 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
11596 is a symbolic link.
11597 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
11598 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
11600 @item --preserve-root
11601 @opindex --preserve-root
11602 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11603 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11604 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11605 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11607 @item --no-preserve-root
11608 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11609 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11610 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11611 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11613 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11614 @opindex --reference
11615 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
11616 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
11617 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
11624 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
11625 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
11626 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
11627 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
11628 its referent is being changed.
11633 @opindex --recursive
11634 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
11635 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
11638 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11641 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11642 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11645 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11654 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
11657 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
11658 chown root:staff /u
11660 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
11665 @node chgrp invocation
11666 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
11669 @cindex group ownership, changing
11670 @cindex changing group ownership
11672 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
11673 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
11674 or to the group of an existing reference file. @xref{chown invocation}.
11678 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11682 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
11683 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
11684 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
11686 @chownGroupRestrictions
11688 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11696 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
11697 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
11706 @cindex error messages, omitting
11707 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
11710 @item --dereference
11711 @opindex --dereference
11712 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
11714 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
11715 This is the default when not operating recursively.
11716 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11719 @itemx --no-dereference
11721 @opindex --no-dereference
11722 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
11724 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
11725 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
11726 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
11727 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
11728 is a symbolic link.
11729 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
11730 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
11732 @item --preserve-root
11733 @opindex --preserve-root
11734 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11735 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11736 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11737 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11739 @item --no-preserve-root
11740 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11741 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11742 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11743 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11745 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11746 @opindex --reference
11747 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
11748 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
11749 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
11755 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
11756 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
11757 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
11758 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
11759 its referent is being changed.
11764 @opindex --recursive
11765 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
11766 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
11769 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11772 @warnOptDerefWithRec
11773 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11776 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
11785 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
11788 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
11793 @node chmod invocation
11794 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
11797 @cindex changing access permissions
11798 @cindex access permissions, changing
11799 @cindex permissions, changing access
11801 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
11804 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@}@c
11808 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
11809 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
11810 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
11811 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
11812 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
11813 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
11814 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
11815 recursive directory traversals.
11817 Only a process whose effective user ID matches the user ID of the file,
11818 or a process with appropriate privileges, is permitted to change the
11819 file mode bits of a file.
11821 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
11822 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
11823 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
11824 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
11825 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
11826 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
11827 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
11828 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
11830 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
11831 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
11832 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
11833 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
11834 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
11835 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
11836 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
11838 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11846 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
11855 @cindex error messages, omitting
11856 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
11859 @item --preserve-root
11860 @opindex --preserve-root
11861 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
11862 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
11863 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
11864 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11866 @item --no-preserve-root
11867 @opindex --no-preserve-root
11868 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
11869 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
11870 @xref{Treating / specially}.
11876 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
11878 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
11879 @opindex --reference
11880 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
11881 @xref{File permissions}.
11882 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
11883 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
11888 @opindex --recursive
11889 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
11890 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
11899 # Change file permissions of FOO to be world readable
11900 # and user writable, with no other permissions.
11904 # Add user and group execute permissions to FOO.
11908 # Set file permissions of DIR and subsidiary files to
11909 # be the umask default, assuming execute permissions for
11910 # directories and for files already executable.
11911 chmod -R a=,+rwX dir
11915 @node touch invocation
11916 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
11919 @cindex changing file timestamps
11920 @cindex file timestamps, changing
11921 @cindex timestamps, changing file
11923 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification timestamps of the
11924 specified files. Synopsis:
11927 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
11930 @cindex empty files, creating
11931 Any @var{file} argument that does not exist is created empty, unless
11932 option @option{--no-create} (@option{-c}) or @option{--no-dereference}
11933 (@option{-h}) was in effect.
11935 A @var{file} argument string of @samp{-} is handled specially and
11936 causes @command{touch} to change the times of the file associated with
11939 By default, @command{touch} sets file timestamps to the current time.
11940 Because @command{touch} acts on its operands left to right, the
11941 resulting timestamps of earlier and later operands may disagree.
11943 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
11944 When setting file timestamps to the current time, @command{touch} can
11945 change the timestamps for files that the user does not own but has
11946 write permission for. Otherwise, the user must own the files. Some
11947 older systems have a further restriction: the user must own the files
11948 unless both the access and modification timestamps are being set to the
11951 The @command{touch} command cannot set a file's status change timestamp to
11952 a user-specified value, and cannot change the file's birth time (if
11953 supported) at all. Also, @command{touch} has issues similar to those
11954 affecting all programs that update file timestamps. For example,
11955 @command{touch} may set a file's timestamp to a value that differs
11956 slightly from the requested time. @xref{File timestamps}.
11959 Timestamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
11960 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
11961 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
11962 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
11963 You can avoid ambiguities during
11964 daylight saving transitions by using UTC timestamps.
11966 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11971 @itemx --time=atime
11972 @itemx --time=access
11976 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
11977 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
11978 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
11979 Change the access timestamp only. @xref{File timestamps}.
11984 @opindex --no-create
11985 Do not warn about or create files that do not exist.
11987 @item -d @var{time}
11988 @itemx --date=@var{time}
11992 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
11993 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
11994 example, @option{--date="2020-07-21 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
11995 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
11996 July 21, 2020 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
11997 minutes east of UTC@. @xref{Date input formats}.
11998 File systems that do not support high-resolution timestamps
11999 silently ignore any excess precision here.
12003 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
12004 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
12007 @itemx --no-dereference
12009 @opindex --no-dereference
12010 @cindex symbolic links, changing time
12012 Attempt to change the timestamps of a symbolic link, rather than what
12013 the link refers to. When using this option, empty files are not
12014 created, but option @option{-c} must also be used to avoid warning
12015 about files that do not exist. Not all systems support changing the
12016 timestamps of symlinks, since underlying system support for this
12017 action was not required until POSIX 2008. Also, on some
12018 systems, the mere act of examining a symbolic link changes the access
12019 timestamp, such that only changes to the modification timestamp will persist
12020 long enough to be observable. When coupled with option @option{-r}, a
12021 reference timestamp is taken from a symbolic link rather than the file
12025 @itemx --time=mtime
12026 @itemx --time=modify
12029 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
12030 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
12031 Change the modification timestamp only.
12033 @item -r @var{file}
12034 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
12036 @opindex --reference
12037 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
12038 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
12039 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
12040 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
12041 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a timestamp
12042 equal to five seconds before the corresponding timestamp for @file{foo}.
12043 If @var{file} is a symbolic link, the reference timestamp is taken
12044 from the target of the symlink, unless @option{-h} was also in effect.
12046 @item -t [[@var{cc}]@var{yy}]@var{mmddhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
12047 @cindex leap seconds
12048 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
12049 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
12050 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{cc}
12051 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
12052 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
12053 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
12054 On the atypical systems that support leap seconds, @var{ss} may be
12059 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
12060 On systems predating POSIX 1003.1-2001,
12061 @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
12062 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
12063 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
12064 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{mmddhhmm}[@var{yy}]} and this
12065 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{yy}, if
12066 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
12067 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
12068 for the other files instead of as a file name.
12069 Although this obsolete behavior can be controlled with the
12070 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
12071 conformance}), portable scripts should avoid commands whose
12072 behavior depends on this variable.
12073 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
12074 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
12079 @node File space usage
12080 @chapter File space usage
12082 @cindex File space usage
12085 No file system can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
12086 how much storage is in use or available, report other file and
12087 file status information, and write buffers to file systems.
12090 * df invocation:: Report file system space usage.
12091 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
12092 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
12093 * sync invocation:: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage.
12094 * truncate invocation:: Shrink or extend the size of a file.
12098 @node df invocation
12099 @section @command{df}: Report file system space usage
12102 @cindex file system usage
12103 @cindex disk usage by file system
12105 @command{df} reports the amount of space used and available on
12106 file systems. Synopsis:
12109 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12112 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
12113 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
12114 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
12116 Normally the space is printed in units of
12117 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
12118 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
12120 For bind mounts and without arguments, @command{df} only outputs the statistics
12121 for that device with the shortest mount point name in the list of file systems
12122 (@var{mtab}), i.e., it hides duplicate entries, unless the @option{-a} option is
12125 With the same logic, @command{df} elides a mount entry of a dummy pseudo device
12126 if there is another mount entry of a real block device for that mount point with
12127 the same device number, e.g. the early-boot pseudo file system @samp{rootfs} is
12128 not shown per default when already the real root device has been mounted.
12130 @cindex disk device file
12131 @cindex device file
12132 If an argument @var{file} resolves to a special file containing
12133 a mounted file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that
12134 file system rather than on the file system containing the device node.
12135 GNU @command{df} does not attempt to determine the usage
12136 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
12137 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system structures.
12139 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12147 @cindex ignore file systems
12148 Include in the listing dummy, duplicate, or inaccessible file systems, which
12149 are omitted by default. Dummy file systems are typically special purpose
12150 pseudo file systems such as @samp{/proc}, with no associated storage.
12151 Duplicate file systems are local or remote file systems that are mounted
12152 at separate locations in the local file hierarchy, or bind mounted locations.
12153 Inaccessible file systems are those which are mounted but subsequently
12154 over-mounted by another file system at that point, or otherwise inaccessible
12155 due to permissions of the mount point etc.
12157 @item -B @var{size}
12158 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
12160 @opindex --block-size
12161 @cindex file system sizes
12162 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
12163 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
12169 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
12175 @cindex inode usage
12176 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
12177 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
12178 permissions, timestamps, and location on the file system.
12182 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
12183 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12184 (@pxref{Block size}).
12185 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
12191 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
12192 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
12197 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
12198 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
12199 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
12200 file systems, but on some systems (notably Solaris) the results may be slightly
12201 out of date. This is the default.
12204 @itemx --output[=@var{field_list}]
12206 Use the output format defined by @var{field_list}, or print all fields if
12207 @var{field_list} is omitted. In the latter case, the order of the columns
12208 conforms to the order of the field descriptions below.
12210 The use of the @option{--output} together with each of the options @option{-i},
12211 @option{-P}, and @option{-T} is mutually exclusive.
12213 FIELD_LIST is a comma-separated list of columns to be included in @command{df}'s
12214 output and therefore effectively controls the order of output columns.
12215 Each field can thus be used at the place of choice, but yet must only be
12218 Valid field names in the @var{field_list} are:
12221 The source of the mount point, usually a device.
12226 Total number of inodes.
12228 Number of used inodes.
12230 Number of available inodes.
12232 Percentage of @var{iused} divided by @var{itotal}.
12235 Total number of blocks.
12237 Number of used blocks.
12239 Number of available blocks.
12241 Percentage of @var{used} divided by @var{size}.
12244 The file name if specified on the command line.
12249 The fields for block and inodes statistics are affected by the scaling
12250 options like @option{-h} as usual.
12252 The definition of the @var{field_list} can even be split among several
12253 @option{--output} uses.
12257 # Print the TARGET (i.e., the mount point) along with their percentage
12258 # statistic regarding the blocks and the inodes.
12259 df --out=target --output=pcent,ipcent
12261 # Print all available fields.
12267 @itemx --portability
12269 @opindex --portability
12270 @cindex one-line output format
12271 @cindex POSIX output format
12272 @cindex portable output format
12273 @cindex output format, portable
12274 Use the POSIX output format. This is like the default format except
12279 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
12280 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
12281 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
12282 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
12285 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to POSIX.
12288 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
12289 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
12290 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
12291 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
12292 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
12299 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
12300 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
12301 some systems (notably Solaris), doing this yields more up to date results,
12302 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
12303 there are many or very busy file systems.
12307 @cindex grand total of file system size, usage and available space
12308 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
12309 been processed. This can be used to find out the total size, usage
12310 and available space of all listed devices. If no arguments are specified
12311 df will try harder to elide file systems insignificant to the total
12312 available space, by suppressing duplicate remote file systems.
12314 For the grand total line, @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the
12315 @var{source} column, and @samp{"-"} into the @var{target} column.
12316 If there is no @var{source} column (see @option{--output}), then
12317 @command{df} prints @samp{"total"} into the @var{target} column,
12320 @item -t @var{fstype}
12321 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
12324 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
12325 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
12326 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
12327 By default, nothing is omitted.
12330 @itemx --print-type
12332 @opindex --print-type
12333 @cindex file system types, printing
12334 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
12335 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
12336 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
12337 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
12342 @cindex NFS file system type
12343 An NFS file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
12344 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
12347 @item ext2@r{, }ext3@r{, }ext4@r{, }xfs@r{, }btrfs@dots{}
12348 @cindex Linux file system types
12349 @cindex local file system types
12350 @opindex ext2 @r{file system type}
12351 @opindex ext3 @r{file system type}
12352 @opindex ext4 @r{file system type}
12353 @opindex xfs @r{file system type}
12354 @opindex btrfs @r{file system type}
12355 A file system on a locally-mounted device. (The system might even
12356 support more than one type here; GNU/Linux does.)
12358 @item iso9660@r{, }cdfs
12359 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
12360 @cindex DVD file system type
12361 @cindex ISO9660 file system type
12362 @opindex iso9660 @r{file system type}
12363 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
12364 A file system on a CD or DVD drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
12365 systems use @samp{iso9660}.
12368 @cindex NTFS file system
12369 @cindex DOS file system
12370 @cindex MS-DOS file system
12371 @cindex MS-Windows file system
12372 @opindex ntfs @r{file system file}
12373 @opindex fat @r{file system file}
12374 File systems used by MS-Windows / MS-DOS.
12378 @item -x @var{fstype}
12379 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
12381 @opindex --exclude-type
12382 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
12383 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
12384 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
12387 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
12391 @command{df} is installed only on systems that have usable mount tables,
12392 so portable scripts should not rely on its existence.
12395 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
12396 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
12397 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
12398 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
12400 Since the list of file systems (@var{mtab}) is needed to determine the
12401 file system type, failure includes the cases when that list cannot
12402 be read and one or more of the options @option{-a}, @option{-l}, @option{-t}
12403 or @option{-x} is used together with a file name argument.
12406 @node du invocation
12407 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
12410 @cindex file space usage
12411 @cindex disk usage for files
12413 @command{du} reports the space needed to represent a set of files.
12417 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12420 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the space needed to represent
12421 the files at or under the current directory.
12422 Normally the space is printed in units of
12423 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
12424 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
12426 If two or more hard links point to the same file, only one of the hard
12427 links is counted. The @var{file} argument order affects which links
12428 are counted, and changing the argument order may change the numbers
12429 and entries that @command{du} outputs.
12431 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12441 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
12443 @item --apparent-size
12444 @opindex --apparent-size
12445 Print apparent sizes, rather than file system usage. The apparent size of a
12446 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
12447 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
12448 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
12449 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
12450 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of file system space, depending on
12451 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
12452 However, a sparse file created with this command:
12455 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
12459 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
12460 file systems, it actually uses almost no space.
12462 Apparent sizes are meaningful only for regular files and symbolic links.
12463 Other file types do not contribute to apparent size.
12465 @item -B @var{size}
12466 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
12468 @opindex --block-size
12470 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
12471 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
12477 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
12483 @cindex grand total of file system space
12484 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
12485 been processed. This can be used to find out the total file system usage of
12486 a given set of files or directories.
12489 @itemx --dereference-args
12491 @opindex --dereference-args
12492 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
12493 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
12494 out the file system usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
12495 are often symbolic links.
12497 @item -d @var{depth}
12498 @itemx --max-depth=@var{depth}
12499 @opindex -d @var{depth}
12500 @opindex --max-depth=@var{depth}
12501 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
12502 Show the total for each directory (and file if @option{--all}) that is at
12503 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
12504 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
12506 @c --files0-from=FILE
12507 @filesZeroFromOption{du,, with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option}
12511 Equivalent to @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
12517 @cindex inode usage, dereferencing in @command{du}
12518 List inode usage information instead of block usage.
12519 This option is useful for finding directories which contain many files, and
12520 therefore eat up most of the inodes space of a file system (see @command{df},
12521 option @option{--inodes}).
12522 It can well be combined with the options @option{-a}, @option{-c},
12523 @option{-h}, @option{-l}, @option{-s}, @option{-S}, @option{-t} and
12524 @option{-x}; however, passing other options regarding the block size, for
12525 example @option{-b}, @option{-m} and @option{--apparent-size}, is ignored.
12529 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
12530 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12531 (@pxref{Block size}).
12532 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
12535 @itemx --dereference
12537 @opindex --dereference
12538 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
12539 Dereference symbolic links (show the file system space used by the file
12540 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
12544 @itemx --count-links
12546 @opindex --count-links
12547 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
12548 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
12553 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
12554 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
12555 (@pxref{Block size}).
12556 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
12559 @itemx --no-dereference
12561 @opindex --no-dereference
12562 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
12563 For each symbolic link encountered by @command{du},
12564 consider the file system space used by the symbolic link itself.
12567 @itemx --separate-dirs
12569 @opindex --separate-dirs
12570 Normally, in the output of @command{du} (when not using @option{--summarize}),
12571 the size listed next to a directory name, @var{d}, represents the sum
12572 of sizes of all entries beneath @var{d} as well as the size of @var{d} itself.
12573 With @option{--separate-dirs}, the size reported for a directory name,
12574 @var{d}, will exclude the size of any subdirectories.
12581 @opindex --summarize
12582 Display only a total for each argument.
12584 @item -t @var{size}
12585 @itemx --threshold=@var{size}
12587 @opindex --threshold
12588 Exclude entries based on a given @var{size}. The @var{size} refers to used
12589 blocks in normal mode (@pxref{Block size}), or inodes count in conjunction
12590 with the @option{--inodes} option.
12592 If @var{size} is positive, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
12593 greater than or equal to that.
12595 If @var{size} is negative, then @command{du} will only print entries with a size
12596 smaller than or equal to that.
12598 Although GNU @command{find} can be used to find files of a certain size,
12599 @command{du}'s @option{--threshold} option can be used to also filter
12600 directories based on a given size.
12602 When combined with the @option{--apparent-size} option, the
12603 @option{--threshold} option elides entries based on apparent size.
12604 When combined with the @option{--inodes} option, it elides entries
12605 based on inode counts.
12607 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories with a size
12608 greater than or equal to 200 megabytes:
12611 du --threshold=200MB
12614 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories and
12615 files -- note the @option{-a} -- with an apparent size smaller than or
12616 equal to 500 bytes:
12619 du -a -t -500 --apparent-size
12622 Here's how you would use @option{--threshold} to find directories on the root
12623 file system with more than 20000 inodes used in the directory tree below:
12626 du --inodes -x --threshold=20000 /
12632 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
12633 Show the most recent modification timestamp (mtime) of any file in the
12634 directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12637 @itemx --time=status
12640 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
12641 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
12642 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
12643 Show the most recent status change timestamp (ctime) of any file in
12644 the directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12647 @itemx --time=access
12649 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
12650 @opindex access timestamp@r{, show the most recent}
12651 Show the most recent access timestamp (atime) of any file in the
12652 directory, or any of its subdirectories. @xref{File timestamps}.
12654 @item --time-style=@var{style}
12655 @opindex --time-style
12657 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
12658 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
12659 be one of the following:
12662 @item +@var{format}
12664 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
12665 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
12666 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
12667 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2020-07-21 23:45:56}. As
12668 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
12669 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12672 List timestamps in full using ISO 8601-like date, time, and time zone
12673 components with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21
12674 23:45:56.477817180 -0400}. This style is equivalent to
12675 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
12678 List ISO 8601 date and time components with minute precision, e.g.,
12679 @samp{2020-07-21 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
12680 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
12681 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
12684 List ISO 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21}.
12685 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
12689 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
12690 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
12691 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
12692 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
12693 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
12694 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
12695 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
12697 @item -X @var{file}
12698 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{file}
12699 @opindex -X @var{file}
12700 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{file}
12701 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
12702 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{file},
12703 one per line. If @var{file} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
12706 @item --exclude=@var{pattern}
12707 @opindex --exclude=@var{pattern}
12708 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
12709 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{pattern}.
12710 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
12714 @itemx --one-file-system
12716 @opindex --one-file-system
12717 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
12718 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
12719 the argument being processed is on.
12723 Since @command{du} relies on information reported by the operating
12724 system, its output might not reflect the space consumed in the
12725 underlying devices. For example;
12729 Operating systems normally do not report device space consumed by
12730 duplicate or backup blocks, error correction bits, and so forth.
12731 This causes @command{du} to underestimate the device space actually used.
12734 @cindex copy-on-write and @command{du}
12735 In file systems that use copy-on-write, if two distinct files share
12736 space the output of @command{du} typically counts the space that would
12737 be consumed if all files' non-holes were rewritten, not the space
12738 currently consumed.
12741 @cindex compression and @command{du}
12742 In file systems that use compression, the operating system might
12743 report the uncompressed space. (If it does report the compressed space,
12744 that report might change after one merely overwrites existing file data.)
12747 @cindex networked file systems and @command{du}
12748 Networked file systems historically have had difficulty communicating
12749 accurate file system information from server to client.
12753 For these reasons @command{du} might better be thought of as an
12754 estimate of the size of a @command{tar} or other conventional backup
12755 for a set of files, rather than as a measure of space consumed in the
12756 underlying devices.
12761 @node stat invocation
12762 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
12765 @cindex file status
12766 @cindex file system status
12768 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
12771 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
12774 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
12775 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
12776 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
12777 also give information about the files the links point to.
12779 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{stat}
12784 @itemx --dereference
12786 @opindex --dereference
12787 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
12788 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
12789 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
12790 by each symbolic link argument.
12791 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
12794 @itemx --file-system
12796 @opindex --file-system
12797 @cindex file systems
12798 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
12799 instead of information about the files themselves.
12800 This option implies the @option{-L} option.
12802 @item --cached=@var{mode}
12803 @opindex --cached=@var{mode}
12804 @cindex attribute caching
12805 Control how attributes are read from the file system;
12806 if supported by the system. This allows one to
12807 control the trade-off between freshness and efficiency
12808 of attribute access, especially useful with remote file systems.
12813 Always read the already cached attributes if available.
12816 Always synchronize with the latest file system attributes.
12817 This also mounts automounted files.
12820 Leave the caching behavior to the underlying file system.
12825 @itemx --format=@var{format}
12827 @opindex --format=@var{format}
12828 @cindex output format
12829 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
12830 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
12831 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
12832 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
12834 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
12839 @item --printf=@var{format}
12840 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
12841 @cindex output format
12842 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
12843 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
12844 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
12845 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
12846 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
12847 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
12849 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
12858 @cindex terse output
12859 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
12861 The output of the following commands are identical and the @option{--format}
12862 also identifies the items printed (in fuller form) in the default format.
12863 Note the format string would include another @samp{%C} at the end with an
12864 active SELinux security context.
12866 $ stat --format="%n %s %b %f %u %g %D %i %h %t %T %X %Y %Z %W %o" ...
12870 The same illustrating terse output in @option{--file-system} mode:
12872 $ stat -f --format="%n %i %l %t %s %S %b %f %a %c %d" ...
12873 $ stat -f --terse ...
12877 The valid @var{format} directives for files with @option{--format} and
12878 @option{--printf} are:
12881 @item %a -- Permission bits in octal (note @samp{#} and @samp{0} printf flags)
12882 @item %A -- Permission bits in symbolic form (similar to @command{ls -ld})
12883 @item %b -- Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
12884 @item %B -- The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
12885 @item %C -- The SELinux security context of a file, if available
12886 @item %d -- Device number in decimal (st_dev)
12887 @item %D -- Device number in hex (st_dev)
12888 @item %Hd -- Major device number in decimal
12889 @item %Ld -- Minor device number in decimal
12890 @item %f -- Raw mode in hex
12891 @item %F -- File type
12892 @item %g -- Group ID of owner
12893 @item %G -- Group name of owner
12894 @item %h -- Number of hard links
12895 @item %i -- Inode number
12896 @item %m -- Mount point (See note below)
12897 @item %n -- File name
12898 @item %N -- Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link (see below)
12899 @item %o -- Optimal I/O transfer size hint
12900 @item %s -- Total size, in bytes
12901 @item %r -- Device type in decimal (st_rdev)
12902 @item %R -- Device type in hex (st_rdev)
12903 @item %Hr -- Major device type in decimal (see below)
12904 @item %Lr -- Minor device type in decimal (see below)
12905 @item %t -- Major device type in hex (see below)
12906 @item %T -- Minor device type in hex (see below)
12907 @item %u -- User ID of owner
12908 @item %U -- User name of owner
12909 @item %w -- Time of file birth, or @samp{-} if unknown
12910 @item %W -- Time of file birth as seconds since Epoch, or @samp{0}
12911 @item %x -- Time of last access
12912 @item %X -- Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
12913 @item %y -- Time of last data modification
12914 @item %Y -- Time of last data modification as seconds since Epoch
12915 @item %z -- Time of last status change
12916 @item %Z -- Time of last status change as seconds since Epoch
12919 The @samp{%a} format prints the octal mode, and so it is useful
12920 to control the zero padding of the output with the @samp{#} and @samp{0}
12921 printf flags. For example to pad to at least 3 wide while making larger
12922 numbers unambiguously octal, you can use @samp{%#03a}.
12924 The @samp{%N} format can be set with the environment variable
12925 @env{QUOTING_STYLE}@. If that environment variable is not set,
12926 the default value is @samp{shell-escape-always}. Valid quoting styles are:
12929 The @samp{r}, @samp{R}, @samp{%t}, and @samp{%T} formats operate on the st_rdev
12930 member of the stat(2) structure, i.e., the represented device rather than
12931 the containing device, and so are only defined for character and block
12932 special files. On some systems or file types, st_rdev may be used to
12933 represent other quantities.
12935 The @samp{%W}, @samp{%X}, @samp{%Y}, and @samp{%Z} formats accept a
12936 precision preceded by a period to specify the number of digits to
12937 print after the decimal point. For example, @samp{%.3X} outputs the
12938 access timestamp to millisecond precision. If a period is given but no
12939 precision, @command{stat} uses 9 digits, so @samp{%.X} is equivalent to
12940 @samp{%.9X}@. When discarding excess precision, timestamps are truncated
12941 toward minus infinity.
12945 $ stat -c '[%015Y]' /usr
12948 $ stat -c '[%15Y]' /usr
12950 $ stat -c '[%-15Y]' /usr
12953 $ stat -c '[%.3Y]' /usr
12955 $ stat -c '[%.Y]' /usr
12956 [1288929712.114951834]
12959 The mount point printed by @samp{%m} is similar to that output
12960 by @command{df}, except that:
12963 stat does not dereference symlinks by default
12964 (unless @option{-L} is specified)
12966 stat does not search for specified device nodes in the
12967 file system list, instead operating on them directly
12970 stat outputs the alias for a bind mounted file, rather than
12971 the initial mount point of its backing device.
12972 One can recursively call stat until there is no change in output,
12973 to get the current base mount point
12976 When listing file system information (@option{--file-system} (@option{-f})),
12977 you must use a different set of @var{format} directives:
12980 @item %a -- Free blocks available to non-super-user
12981 @item %b -- Total data blocks in file system
12982 @item %c -- Total file nodes in file system
12983 @item %d -- Free file nodes in file system
12984 @item %f -- Free blocks in file system
12985 @item %i -- File System ID in hex
12986 @item %l -- Maximum length of file names
12987 @item %n -- File name
12988 @item %s -- Block size (for faster transfers)
12989 @item %S -- Fundamental block size (for block counts)
12990 @item %t -- Type in hex
12991 @item %T -- Type in human readable form
12995 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
12996 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
12997 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
12998 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
13003 @node sync invocation
13004 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
13007 @cindex synchronize file system and memory
13008 @cindex Synchronize cached writes to persistent storage
13010 @command{sync} synchronizes in memory files or file systems to persistent
13014 sync [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
13017 @cindex superblock, writing
13018 @cindex inodes, written buffered
13019 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to the storage device.
13021 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
13022 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
13023 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync},
13024 @code{syncfs}, @code{fsync}, and @code{fdatasync} system calls.
13026 @cindex crashes and corruption
13027 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) device
13028 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
13029 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
13030 result. The @command{sync} command instructs the kernel to write
13031 data in memory to persistent storage.
13033 If any argument is specified then only those files will be
13034 synchronized using the fsync(2) syscall by default.
13036 If at least one file is specified, it is possible to change the
13037 synchronization method with the following options. Also see
13038 @ref{Common options}.
13044 Use fdatasync(2) to sync only the data for the file,
13045 and any metadata required to maintain file system consistency.
13048 @itemx --file-system
13049 @opindex --file-system
13050 Synchronize all the I/O waiting for the file systems that contain the file,
13051 using the syscall syncfs(2). Note you would usually @emph{not} specify
13052 this option if passing a device node like @samp{/dev/sda} for example,
13053 as that would sync the containing file system rather than the referenced one.
13054 Note also that depending on the system, passing individual device nodes or files
13055 may have different sync characteristics than using no arguments.
13056 I.e., arguments passed to fsync(2) may provide greater guarantees through
13057 write barriers, than a global sync(2) used when no arguments are provided.
13063 @node truncate invocation
13064 @section @command{truncate}: Shrink or extend the size of a file
13067 @cindex truncating, file sizes
13069 @command{truncate} shrinks or extends the size of each @var{file} to the
13070 specified size. Synopsis:
13073 truncate @var{option}@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
13076 @cindex files, creating
13077 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created.
13079 @cindex sparse files, creating
13080 @cindex holes, creating files with
13081 If a @var{file} is larger than the specified size, the extra data is lost.
13082 If a @var{file} is shorter, it is extended and the sparse extended part
13083 (or hole) reads as zero bytes.
13085 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13092 @opindex --no-create
13093 Do not create files that do not exist.
13098 @opindex --io-blocks
13099 Treat @var{size} as number of I/O blocks of the @var{file} rather than bytes.
13101 @item -r @var{rfile}
13102 @itemx --reference=@var{rfile}
13104 @opindex --reference
13105 Base the size of each @var{file} on the size of @var{rfile}.
13107 @item -s @var{size}
13108 @itemx --size=@var{size}
13111 Set or adjust the size of each @var{file} according to @var{size}.
13112 @var{size} is in bytes unless @option{--io-blocks} is specified.
13113 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
13115 @var{size} may also be prefixed by one of the following to adjust
13116 the size of each @var{file} based on its current size:
13118 @samp{+} => extend by
13119 @samp{-} => reduce by
13120 @samp{<} => at most
13121 @samp{>} => at least
13122 @samp{/} => round down to multiple of
13123 @samp{%} => round up to multiple of
13131 @node Printing text
13132 @chapter Printing text
13134 @cindex printing text, commands for
13135 @cindex commands for printing text
13137 This section describes commands that display text strings.
13140 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
13141 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
13142 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
13146 @node echo invocation
13147 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
13150 @cindex displaying text
13151 @cindex printing text
13152 @cindex text, displaying
13153 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
13155 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
13156 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
13159 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
13162 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{echo}
13164 Due to historical and backwards compatibility reasons, certain bare option-like
13165 strings cannot be passed to @command{echo} as non-option arguments.
13166 It is therefore not advisable to use @command{echo} for printing unknown or
13167 variable arguments. The @command{printf} command is recommended as a more
13168 portable and flexible replacement for tasks historically performed by
13169 @command{echo}. @xref{printf invocation}.
13171 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13172 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
13173 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
13179 Do not output the trailing newline.
13183 @cindex backslash escapes
13184 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
13193 produce no further output
13209 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
13210 (zero to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
13211 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
13213 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
13214 (one to three octal digits), if @var{nnn} is
13215 a nine-bit value, the ninth bit is ignored
13217 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
13218 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
13223 @cindex backslash escapes
13224 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
13225 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
13226 specified, the last one given takes effect.
13230 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13231 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
13232 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
13233 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
13234 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
13235 plain @samp{hello}. Also backslash escapes are always enabled.
13236 Note to echo the string @samp{-n}, one of the characters
13237 can be escaped in either octal or hexadecimal representation.
13238 For example, @code{echo -e '\x2dn'}.
13240 POSIX does not require support for any options, and says
13241 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
13242 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is @option{-n}.
13243 Portable programs should use the @command{printf} command instead.
13244 @xref{printf invocation}.
13249 @node printf invocation
13250 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
13253 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
13256 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
13259 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
13260 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
13261 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function.
13262 @xref{Output Conversion Syntax,, @command{printf} format directives,
13263 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for details.
13264 The differences are listed below.
13266 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{printf}
13271 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
13272 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
13276 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
13277 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
13278 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
13282 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
13283 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
13284 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
13287 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
13288 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
13289 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
13290 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
13295 An additional directive @samp{%b}, prints its
13296 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
13297 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
13298 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits. If
13299 @samp{\@var{ooo}} is nine-bit value, ignore the ninth bit.
13300 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
13301 from the converted string.
13305 An additional directive @samp{%q}, prints its argument string
13306 in a format that can be reused as input by most shells.
13307 Non-printable characters are escaped with the POSIX proposed @samp{$''} syntax,
13308 and shell metacharacters are quoted appropriately.
13309 This is an equivalent format to @command{ls --quoting=shell-escape} output.
13312 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
13313 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
13317 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
13318 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
13319 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
13320 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
13321 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
13322 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
13323 @samp{97} on hosts that use the ASCII character set, since
13324 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in ASCII.
13329 A floating point argument is interpreted according to
13330 the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of either the current or the C locale,
13331 and is printed according to the current locale.
13332 For example, in a locale whose decimal point character is a comma,
13333 the command @samp{printf '%g %g' 2,5 2.5} outputs @samp{2,5 2,5}.
13334 @xref{Floating point}.
13338 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
13339 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a byte to print,
13340 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
13341 digits) specifying a character to print.
13342 Note however that when @samp{\@var{ooo}} specifies a number larger than 255,
13343 @command{printf} ignores the ninth bit.
13344 For example, @samp{printf '\400'} is equivalent to @samp{printf '\0'}.
13349 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
13351 @command{printf} interprets two syntaxes for specifying Unicode
13352 (ISO/IEC 10646) characters.
13353 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode characters, specified as
13354 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
13355 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
13356 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
13357 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale. Unicode characters in the range
13358 U+D800@dots{}U+DFFF cannot be specified by this syntax.
13359 This syntax fully supports the universal character subset
13360 introduced in ISO C 99.
13362 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
13363 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
13364 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
13365 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
13367 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
13368 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
13371 $ env printf '\u20AC 14.95'
13375 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
13376 (ISO-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
13379 $ env printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
13383 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
13385 Note that in these examples, the @command{printf} command has been
13386 invoked via @command{env} to ensure that we run the program found via
13387 your shell's search path, and not a shell alias or a built-in function.
13389 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
13390 values of each character one by one. ASCII characters mixed with \u
13391 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
13392 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
13393 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
13394 this text in a locale-independent way:
13397 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_TW.big5 env printf \
13398 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
13399 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
13400 | sed -e "s|^|env printf '|" -e "s|%|%%|g" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
13404 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
13405 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
13406 Options must precede operands.
13411 @node yes invocation
13412 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
13415 @cindex repeated output of a string
13417 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
13418 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
13419 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
13421 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
13423 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
13424 To output an argument that begins with
13425 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
13426 @xref{Common options}.
13430 @chapter Conditions
13433 @cindex commands for exit status
13434 @cindex exit status commands
13436 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
13437 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
13438 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
13442 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
13443 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
13444 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
13445 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
13449 @node false invocation
13450 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
13453 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
13454 @cindex failure exit status
13455 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
13457 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
13458 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
13459 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
13460 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
13461 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
13462 command, not the one documented here.
13464 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
13466 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
13467 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
13468 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
13470 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
13471 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
13472 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
13474 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
13475 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
13479 @node true invocation
13480 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
13483 @cindex do nothing, successfully
13485 @cindex successful exit
13486 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
13488 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
13489 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
13490 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
13491 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
13492 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
13493 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
13494 command, not the one documented here.
13496 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
13498 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
13499 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
13500 option, and with standard
13501 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
13502 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
13505 $ ./true --version >&-
13506 ./true: write error: Bad file number
13507 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
13508 ./true: write error: No space left on device
13511 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
13512 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
13513 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
13515 @node test invocation
13516 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
13519 @cindex check file types
13520 @cindex compare values
13521 @cindex expression evaluation
13523 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
13524 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
13525 expression must be a separate argument.
13527 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
13528 comparison operators.
13530 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
13531 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
13532 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
13533 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
13534 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
13535 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
13541 test @var{expression}
13543 [ @var{expression} ]
13548 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{test}
13550 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
13551 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
13552 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true
13553 otherwise. The argument
13554 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
13555 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
13556 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
13557 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
13558 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
13560 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
13564 0 if the expression is true,
13565 1 if the expression is false,
13566 2 if an error occurred.
13570 * File type tests:: @code{-[bcdfhLpSt]}
13571 * Access permission tests:: @code{-[gkruwxOG]}
13572 * File characteristic tests:: @code{-e -s -nt -ot -ef}
13573 * String tests:: @code{-z -n = == !=}
13574 * Numeric tests:: @code{-eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge}
13575 * Connectives for test:: @code{! -a -o}
13579 @node File type tests
13580 @subsection File type tests
13582 @cindex file type tests
13584 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
13585 but not all files are the same!)
13589 @item -b @var{file}
13591 @cindex block special check
13592 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
13594 @item -c @var{file}
13596 @cindex character special check
13597 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
13599 @item -d @var{file}
13601 @cindex directory check
13602 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
13604 @item -f @var{file}
13606 @cindex regular file check
13607 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
13609 @item -h @var{file}
13610 @itemx -L @var{file}
13613 @cindex symbolic link check
13614 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
13615 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
13616 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
13618 @item -p @var{file}
13620 @cindex named pipe check
13621 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
13623 @item -S @var{file}
13625 @cindex socket check
13626 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
13630 @cindex terminal check
13631 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
13637 @node Access permission tests
13638 @subsection Access permission tests
13640 @cindex access permission tests
13641 @cindex permission tests
13643 These options test for particular access permissions.
13647 @item -g @var{file}
13649 @cindex set-group-ID check
13650 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
13652 @item -k @var{file}
13654 @cindex sticky bit check
13655 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
13657 @item -r @var{file}
13659 @cindex readable file check
13660 True if @var{file} exists and the user has read access.
13662 @item -u @var{file}
13664 @cindex set-user-ID check
13665 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
13667 @item -w @var{file}
13669 @cindex writable file check
13670 True if @var{file} exists and the user has write access.
13672 @item -x @var{file}
13674 @cindex executable file check
13675 True if @var{file} exists and the user has execute access
13676 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
13678 @item -O @var{file}
13680 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
13681 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
13683 @item -G @var{file}
13685 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
13686 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
13690 @node File characteristic tests
13691 @subsection File characteristic tests
13693 @cindex file characteristic tests
13695 These options test other file characteristics.
13699 @item -e @var{file}
13701 @cindex existence-of-file check
13702 True if @var{file} exists.
13704 @item -s @var{file}
13706 @cindex nonempty file check
13707 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
13709 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
13711 @cindex newer-than file check
13712 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
13713 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
13715 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
13717 @cindex older-than file check
13718 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
13719 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
13721 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
13723 @cindex same file check
13724 @cindex hard link check
13725 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
13726 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
13728 @item -N @var{file}
13730 @cindex mtime-greater-atime file check
13731 True if @var{file} exists and has been modified (mtime) since it was
13738 @subsection String tests
13740 @cindex string tests
13742 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
13743 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
13749 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
13750 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
13754 @item -z @var{string}
13756 @cindex zero-length string check
13757 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
13759 @item -n @var{string}
13760 @itemx @var{string}
13762 @cindex nonzero-length string check
13763 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
13765 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
13767 @cindex equal string check
13768 True if the strings are equal.
13770 @item @var{string1} == @var{string2}
13772 @cindex equal string check
13773 True if the strings are equal (synonym for =).
13774 Note this form is not as portable to other
13775 shells and systems.
13777 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
13779 @cindex not-equal string check
13780 True if the strings are not equal.
13785 @node Numeric tests
13786 @subsection Numeric tests
13788 @cindex numeric tests
13789 @cindex arithmetic tests
13791 Numeric relational operators. The arguments must be entirely numeric
13792 (possibly negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}},
13793 which evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
13797 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
13798 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
13799 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
13800 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
13801 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
13802 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
13809 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
13810 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
13811 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
13818 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
13820 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
13823 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
13827 @node Connectives for test
13828 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
13830 @cindex logical connectives
13831 @cindex connectives, logical
13833 Note it's preferred to use shell logical primitives
13834 rather than these logical connectives internal to @command{test},
13835 because an expression may become ambiguous
13836 depending on the expansion of its parameters.
13838 For example, this becomes ambiguous when @samp{$1}
13839 is set to @samp{'!'} and @samp{$2} to the empty string @samp{''}:
13845 and should be written as:
13848 test "$1" && test "$2"
13851 Note the shell logical primitives also benefit from
13852 short circuit operation, which can be significant
13853 for file attribute tests.
13859 True if @var{expr} is false.
13860 @samp{!} has lower precedence than all parts of @var{expr}.
13861 Note @samp{!} needs to be specified to the left
13862 of a binary expression, I.e., @samp{'!' 1 -gt 2}
13863 rather than @samp{1 '!' -gt 2}.
13864 Also @samp{!} is often a shell special character
13865 and is best used quoted.
13868 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
13870 @cindex logical and operator
13871 @cindex and operator
13872 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
13873 @samp{-a} is left associative,
13874 and has a higher precedence than @samp{-o}.
13876 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
13878 @cindex logical or operator
13879 @cindex or operator
13880 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
13881 @samp{-o} is left associative.
13886 @node expr invocation
13887 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
13890 @cindex expression evaluation
13891 @cindex evaluation of expressions
13893 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
13894 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
13896 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
13897 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
13898 @command{expr} converts
13899 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
13900 depending on the operation being applied to it.
13902 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
13903 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
13904 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
13905 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
13906 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
13907 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
13908 work around this is to use the GNU extension @code{+},
13909 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
13910 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
13911 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
13913 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
13914 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
13915 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
13916 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
13917 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
13918 leading spaces as mentioned above.
13920 @cindex parentheses for grouping
13921 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
13922 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
13923 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
13926 Because @command{expr} uses multiple-precision arithmetic, it works
13927 with integers wider than those of machine registers.
13929 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13930 options}. Options must precede operands.
13932 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
13936 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
13937 1 if the expression is null or 0,
13938 2 if the expression is invalid,
13939 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
13943 * String expressions:: @code{+ : match substr index length}
13944 * Numeric expressions:: @code{+ - * / %}
13945 * Relations for expr:: @code{| & < <= = == != >= >}
13946 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
13950 @node String expressions
13951 @subsection String expressions
13953 @cindex string expressions
13954 @cindex expressions, string
13956 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
13957 have higher precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
13958 the next sections).
13962 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
13963 @cindex pattern matching
13964 @cindex regular expression matching
13965 @cindex matching patterns
13966 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
13967 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
13968 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
13969 then matched against this regular expression.
13971 If @var{regex} does not use @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the @code{:}
13972 expression returns the number of characters matched, or 0 if the match
13975 If @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the @code{:} expression
13976 returns the part of @var{string} that matched the subexpression, or
13977 the null string if the match failed or the subexpression did not
13978 contribute to the match.
13980 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
13981 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
13982 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
13983 expression operators.
13985 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
13986 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
13987 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
13988 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
13989 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
13990 alternatives. These operators are GNU extensions. @xref{Regular Expressions,,
13991 Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}, for details of
13992 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
13994 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
13996 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
13997 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
13999 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
14001 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
14002 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
14003 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
14005 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
14007 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
14008 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
14009 @var{string}, return 0.
14011 @item length @var{string}
14013 Returns the length of @var{string}.
14015 @item + @var{token}
14017 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
14018 or an operator like @code{/}.
14019 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
14020 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
14021 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
14022 This operator is a GNU extension. Portable shell scripts should use
14023 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
14027 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
14028 @code{quote} operator.
14031 @node Numeric expressions
14032 @subsection Numeric expressions
14034 @cindex numeric expressions
14035 @cindex expressions, numeric
14037 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
14038 precedence. These numeric operators have lower precedence than the
14039 string operators described in the previous section, and higher precedence
14040 than the connectives (next section).
14048 @cindex subtraction
14049 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
14050 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
14056 @cindex multiplication
14059 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
14060 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
14065 @node Relations for expr
14066 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
14068 @cindex connectives, logical
14069 @cindex logical connectives
14070 @cindex relations, numeric or string
14072 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
14073 have lower precedence than the string and numeric operators
14074 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
14080 @cindex logical or operator
14081 @cindex or operator
14082 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
14083 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
14084 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
14089 @cindex logical and operator
14090 @cindex and operator
14091 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
14092 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
14095 @item < <= = == != >= >
14102 @cindex comparison operators
14104 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
14105 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
14106 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
14107 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
14108 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
14113 @node Examples of expr
14114 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
14116 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
14117 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
14119 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
14122 foo=$(expr $foo + 1)
14125 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
14126 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
14129 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
14132 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
14140 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
14142 expr index abcdef cz
14145 @error{} expr: syntax error
14146 expr index + index a
14152 @chapter Redirection
14154 @cindex redirection
14155 @cindex commands for redirection
14157 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection} -- ways
14158 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
14159 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
14160 it's described here.
14163 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files or processes.
14167 @node tee invocation
14168 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files or processes
14171 @cindex pipe fitting
14172 @cindex destinations, multiple output
14173 @cindex read from standard input and write to standard output and files
14175 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
14176 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
14177 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
14180 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
14183 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
14184 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
14185 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
14187 In previous versions of GNU Coreutils (5.3.0--8.23),
14188 a @var{file} of @samp{-}
14189 caused @command{tee} to send another copy of input to standard output.
14190 However, as the interleaved output was not very useful, @command{tee} now
14191 conforms to POSIX and treats @samp{-} as a file name.
14193 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14200 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
14204 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
14206 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
14207 Ignore interrupt signals.
14210 @itemx --output-error[=@var{mode}]
14212 @opindex --output-error
14213 Adjust the behavior with errors on the outputs.
14214 In summary @option{-p} allows @command{tee} to operate in a more
14215 appropriate manner with pipes, and to continue to process data
14216 to any remaining outputs, if any pipe outputs exit early.
14217 The default operation when @option{--output-error} is @emph{not}
14218 specified is to exit immediately on error writing to a pipe,
14219 and diagnose errors writing to a non-pipe.
14220 The long form @option{--output-error} option supports selection
14221 between the following @var{mode}s:
14225 Warn on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
14226 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
14227 Exit status indicates failure if any output has an error.
14230 This is the default @var{mode} when not specified,
14231 or when the short form @option{-p} is used.
14232 Warn on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
14233 Writing is continued to still open files/pipes.
14234 Exit immediately if all remaining outputs become broken pipes.
14235 Exit status indicates failure if any non pipe output had an error.
14238 Exit on error opening or writing any output, including pipes.
14241 Exit on error opening or writing any output, except pipes.
14242 Exit immediately if all remaining outputs become broken pipes.
14247 The @command{tee} command is useful when you happen to be transferring a large
14248 amount of data and also want to summarize that data without reading
14249 it a second time. For example, when you are downloading a DVD image,
14250 you often want to verify its signature or checksum right away.
14251 The inefficient way to do it is simply:
14254 wget https://example.com/some.iso && sha1sum some.iso
14257 One problem with the above is that it makes you wait for the
14258 download to complete before starting the time-consuming SHA1 computation.
14259 Perhaps even more importantly, the above requires reading
14260 the DVD image a second time (the first was from the network).
14262 The efficient way to do it is to interleave the download
14263 and SHA1 computation. Then, you'll get the checksum for
14264 free, because the entire process parallelizes so well:
14267 # slightly contrived, to demonstrate process substitution
14268 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14269 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) > dvd.iso
14272 That makes @command{tee} write not just to the expected output file,
14273 but also to a pipe running @command{sha1sum} and saving the final
14274 checksum in a file named @file{dvd.sha1}.
14276 Note, however, that this example relies on a feature of modern shells
14277 called @dfn{process substitution}
14278 (the @samp{>(command)} syntax, above;
14279 @xref{Process Substitution,,Process Substitution, bash,
14280 The Bash Reference Manual}.),
14281 so it works with @command{zsh}, @command{bash}, and @command{ksh},
14282 but not with @command{/bin/sh}. So if you write code like this
14283 in a shell script, be sure to start the script with @samp{#!/bin/bash}.
14285 Note also that if any of the process substitutions (or piped standard output)
14286 might exit early without consuming all the data, the @option{-p} option
14287 is needed to allow @command{tee} to continue to process the input
14288 to any remaining outputs.
14290 Since the above example writes to one file and one process,
14291 a more conventional and portable use of @command{tee} is even better:
14294 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14295 | tee dvd.iso | sha1sum > dvd.sha1
14298 You can extend this example to make @command{tee} write to two processes,
14299 computing MD5 and SHA1 checksums in parallel. In this case,
14300 process substitution is required:
14303 wget -O - https://example.com/dvd.iso \
14304 | tee >(sha1sum > dvd.sha1) \
14305 >(md5sum > dvd.md5) \
14309 This technique is also useful when you want to make a @emph{compressed}
14310 copy of the contents of a pipe.
14311 Consider a tool to graphically summarize file system usage data from
14313 For a large hierarchy, @samp{du -ak} can run for a long time,
14314 and can easily produce terabytes of data, so you won't want to
14315 rerun the command unnecessarily. Nor will you want to save
14316 the uncompressed output.
14318 Doing it the inefficient way, you can't even start the GUI
14319 until after you've compressed all of the @command{du} output:
14322 du -ak | gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz
14323 gzip -d /tmp/du.gz | checkspace -a
14326 With @command{tee} and process substitution, you start the GUI
14327 right away and eliminate the decompression completely:
14330 du -ak | tee >(gzip -9 > /tmp/du.gz) | checkspace -a
14333 Finally, if you regularly create more than one type of
14334 compressed tarball at once, for example when @code{make dist} creates
14335 both @command{gzip}-compressed and @command{bzip2}-compressed tarballs,
14336 there may be a better way.
14337 Typical @command{automake}-generated @file{Makefile} rules create
14338 the two compressed tar archives with commands in sequence, like this
14339 (slightly simplified):
14342 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14343 tar chof - "$tardir" | gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz
14344 tar chof - "$tardir" | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
14347 However, if the hierarchy you are archiving and compressing is larger
14348 than a couple megabytes, and especially if you are using a multi-processor
14349 system with plenty of memory, then you can do much better by reading the
14350 directory contents only once and running the compression programs in parallel:
14353 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14354 tar chof - "$tardir" \
14355 | tee >(gzip -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.gz) \
14356 | bzip2 -9 -c > your-pkg-M.N.tar.bz2
14359 If you want to further process the output from process substitutions,
14360 and those processes write atomically (i.e., write less than the system's
14361 PIPE_BUF size at a time), that's possible with a construct like:
14364 tardir=your-pkg-M.N
14365 tar chof - "$tardir" \
14366 | tee >(md5sum --tag) > >(sha256sum --tag) \
14367 | sort | gpg --clearsign > your-pkg-M.N.tar.sig
14373 @node File name manipulation
14374 @chapter File name manipulation
14376 @cindex file name manipulation
14377 @cindex manipulation of file names
14378 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
14380 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
14383 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
14384 * dirname invocation:: Strip last file name component.
14385 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name validity and portability.
14386 * mktemp invocation:: Create temporary file or directory.
14387 * realpath invocation:: Print resolved file names.
14391 @node basename invocation
14392 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
14395 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
14396 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
14397 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
14398 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
14399 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
14401 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
14402 @var{name}. Synopsis:
14405 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
14406 basename @var{option}@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
14409 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
14410 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
14411 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
14412 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
14415 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
14416 @macro basenameAndDirname
14417 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
14418 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
14419 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
14420 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
14422 @basenameAndDirname
14424 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
14425 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, GNU
14426 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
14427 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
14428 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
14430 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14431 Options must precede operands.
14438 @opindex --multiple
14439 Support more than one argument. Treat every argument as a @var{name}.
14440 With this, an optional @var{suffix} must be specified using the
14441 @option{-s} option.
14443 @item -s @var{suffix}
14444 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
14447 Remove a trailing @var{suffix}.
14448 This option implies the @option{-a} option.
14460 basename /usr/bin/sort
14463 basename include/stdio.h .h
14466 basename -s .h include/stdio.h
14468 # Output "stdio" followed by "stdlib"
14469 basename -a -s .h include/stdio.h include/stdlib.h
14473 @node dirname invocation
14474 @section @command{dirname}: Strip last file name component
14477 @cindex directory components, printing
14478 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
14479 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
14481 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component
14482 of each @var{name}. Slashes on either side of the final component are
14483 also removed. If the string contains no slash, @command{dirname}
14484 prints @samp{.} (meaning the current directory). Synopsis:
14487 dirname [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
14490 @var{name} need not be a file name, but if it is, this operation
14491 effectively lists the directory that contains the final component,
14492 including the case when the final component is itself a directory.
14494 @basenameAndDirname
14496 POSIX allows the implementation to define the results if
14497 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With GNU @command{dirname}, the
14498 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
14499 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
14501 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14514 # Output "/usr/bin".
14515 dirname /usr/bin/sort
14516 dirname /usr/bin//.//
14518 # Output "dir1" followed by "dir2"
14519 dirname dir1/str dir2/str
14526 @node pathchk invocation
14527 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name validity and portability
14530 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
14531 @cindex valid file names, checking for
14532 @cindex portable file names, checking for
14534 @command{pathchk} checks validity and portability of file names. Synopsis:
14537 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
14540 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints an error message if any of
14541 these conditions is true:
14545 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
14546 (execute) permission,
14548 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
14551 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
14552 its file system's maximum.
14555 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long as a file with that
14556 name could be created under the above conditions.
14558 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14559 Options must precede operands.
14565 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
14566 print an error message if any of these conditions is true:
14570 A file name is empty.
14573 A file name contains a character outside the POSIX portable file
14574 name character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{.},
14575 @samp{_}, @samp{-}, and @samp{/}.
14578 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
14579 POSIX minimum limits for portability.
14584 Print an error message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
14585 that begins with @samp{-}.
14587 @item --portability
14588 @opindex --portability
14589 Print an error message if a file name is not portable to all POSIX
14590 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
14594 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
14598 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
14602 @node mktemp invocation
14603 @section @command{mktemp}: Create temporary file or directory
14606 @cindex file names, creating temporary
14607 @cindex directory, creating temporary
14608 @cindex temporary files and directories
14610 @command{mktemp} manages the creation of temporary files and
14611 directories. Synopsis:
14614 mktemp [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{template}]
14617 Safely create a temporary file or directory based on @var{template},
14618 and print its name. If given, @var{template} must include at least
14619 three consecutive @samp{X}s in the last component. If omitted, the template
14620 @samp{tmp.XXXXXXXXXX} is used, and option @option{--tmpdir} is
14621 implied. The final run of @samp{X}s in the @var{template} will be replaced
14622 by alpha-numeric characters; thus, on a case-sensitive file system,
14623 and with a @var{template} including a run of @var{n} instances of @samp{X},
14624 there are @samp{62**@var{n}} potential file names.
14626 Older scripts used to create temporary files by simply joining the
14627 name of the program with the process id (@samp{$$}) as a suffix.
14628 However, that naming scheme is easily predictable, and suffers from a
14629 race condition where the attacker can create an appropriately named
14630 symbolic link, such that when the script then opens a handle to what
14631 it thought was an unused file, it is instead modifying an existing
14632 file. Using the same scheme to create a directory is slightly safer,
14633 since the @command{mkdir} will fail if the target already exists, but
14634 it is still inferior because it allows for denial of service attacks.
14635 Therefore, modern scripts should use the @command{mktemp} command to
14636 guarantee that the generated name will be unpredictable, and that
14637 knowledge of the temporary file name implies that the file was created
14638 by the current script and cannot be modified by other users.
14640 When creating a file, the resulting file has read and write
14641 permissions for the current user, but no permissions for the group or
14642 others; these permissions are reduced if the current umask is more
14645 Here are some examples (although note that if you repeat them, you
14646 will most likely get different file names):
14651 Create a temporary file in the current directory.
14658 Create a temporary file with a known suffix.
14660 $ mktemp --suffix=.txt file-XXXX
14662 $ mktemp file-XXXX-XXXX.txt
14667 Create a secure fifo relative to the user's choice of @env{TMPDIR},
14668 but falling back to the current directory rather than @file{/tmp}.
14669 Note that @command{mktemp} does not create fifos, but can create a
14670 secure directory in which the fifo can live. Exit the shell if the
14671 directory or fifo could not be created.
14673 $ dir=$(mktemp -p "$@{TMPDIR:-.@}" -d dir-XXXX) || exit 1
14675 $ mkfifo "$fifo" || @{ rmdir "$dir"; exit 1; @}
14679 Create and use a temporary file if possible, but ignore failure. The
14680 file will reside in the directory named by @env{TMPDIR}, if specified,
14681 or else in @file{/tmp}.
14683 $ file=$(mktemp -q) && @{
14684 > # Safe to use $file only within this block. Use quotes,
14685 > # since $TMPDIR, and thus $file, may contain whitespace.
14686 > echo ... > "$file"
14692 Act as a semi-random character generator (it is not fully random,
14693 since it is impacted by the contents of the current directory). To
14694 avoid security holes, do not use the resulting names to create a file.
14704 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14711 @opindex --directory
14712 Create a directory rather than a file. The directory will have read,
14713 write, and search permissions for the current user, but no permissions
14714 for the group or others; these permissions are reduced if the current
14715 umask is more restrictive.
14721 Suppress diagnostics about failure to create a file or directory. The
14722 exit status will still reflect whether a file was created.
14728 Generate a temporary name that does not name an existing file, without
14729 changing the file system contents. Using the output of this command
14730 to create a new file is inherently unsafe, as there is a window of
14731 time between generating the name and using it where another process
14732 can create an object by the same name.
14735 @itemx --tmpdir[=@var{dir}]
14738 Treat @var{template} relative to the directory @var{dir}. If
14739 @var{dir} is not specified (only possible with the long option
14740 @option{--tmpdir}) or is the empty string, use the value of
14741 @env{TMPDIR} if available, otherwise use @samp{/tmp}. If this is
14742 specified, @var{template} must not be absolute. However,
14743 @var{template} can still contain slashes, although intermediate
14744 directories must already exist.
14746 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
14748 Append @var{suffix} to the @var{template}. @var{suffix} must not
14749 contain slash. If @option{--suffix} is specified, @var{template} must
14750 end in @samp{X}; if it is not specified, then an appropriate
14751 @option{--suffix} is inferred by finding the last @samp{X} in
14752 @var{template}. This option exists for use with the default
14753 @var{template} and for the creation of a @var{suffix} that starts with
14758 Treat @var{template} as a single file relative to the value of
14759 @env{TMPDIR} if available, or to the directory specified by
14760 @option{-p}, otherwise to @samp{/tmp}. @var{template} must not
14761 contain slashes. This option is deprecated; the use of @option{-p}
14762 without @option{-t} offers better defaults (by favoring the command
14763 line over @env{TMPDIR}) and more flexibility (by allowing intermediate
14768 @cindex exit status of @command{mktemp}
14772 0 if the file was created,
14777 @node realpath invocation
14778 @section @command{realpath}: Print the resolved file name.
14781 @cindex file names, canonicalization
14782 @cindex symlinks, resolution
14783 @cindex canonical file name
14784 @cindex canonicalize a file name
14788 @command{realpath} expands all symbolic links and resolves references to
14789 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and extra @samp{/} characters. By default,
14790 all but the last component of the specified files must exist. Synopsis:
14793 realpath [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
14796 The file name canonicalization functionality overlaps with that of the
14797 @command{readlink} command. This is the preferred command for
14798 canonicalization as it's a more suitable and standard name. In addition
14799 this command supports relative file name processing functionality.
14801 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14806 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
14808 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
14809 Ensure that all components of the specified file names exist.
14810 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{realpath} will output
14811 a diagnostic unless the @option{-q} option is specified, and exit with a
14812 nonzero exit code. A trailing slash requires that the name resolve to a
14816 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
14818 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
14819 If any component of a specified file name is missing or unavailable,
14820 treat it as a directory.
14826 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
14827 but they are resolved after any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
14832 @opindex --physical
14833 Symbolic links are resolved in the specified file names,
14834 and they are resolved before any subsequent @samp{..} components are processed.
14835 This is the default mode of operation.
14841 Suppress diagnostic messages for specified file names.
14843 @item --relative-to=@var{dir}
14844 @opindex --relative-to
14846 Print the resolved file names relative to the specified directory.
14847 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
14848 pertaining to file existence.
14850 @item --relative-base=@var{dir}
14851 @opindex --relative-base
14852 Print the resolved file names as relative @emph{if} the files
14853 are descendants of @var{dir}.
14854 Otherwise, print the resolved file names as absolute.
14855 Note this option honors the @option{-m} and @option{-e} options
14856 pertaining to file existence.
14857 For details about combining @option{--relative-to} and @option{--relative-base},
14858 @pxref{Realpath usage examples}.
14862 @itemx --no-symlinks
14865 @opindex --no-symlinks
14866 Do not resolve symbolic links. Only resolve references to
14867 @samp{/./}, @samp{/../} and remove extra @samp{/} characters.
14868 When combined with the @option{-m} option, realpath operates
14869 only on the file name, and does not touch any actual file.
14875 @cindex exit status of @command{realpath}
14879 0 if all file names were printed without issue.
14884 * Realpath usage examples:: Realpath usage examples.
14888 @node Realpath usage examples
14889 @subsection Realpath usage examples
14891 @opindex --relative-to
14892 @opindex --relative-base
14894 By default, @command{realpath} prints the absolute file name of given files
14895 (symlinks are resolved, @file{words} is resolved to @file{american-english}):
14900 realpath /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14901 @result{} /usr/bin/sort
14903 @result{} /usr/share/dict/american-english
14904 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
14908 With @option{--relative-to}, file names are printed relative to
14909 the given directory:
14913 realpath --relative-to=/usr/bin \
14914 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14916 @result{} ../../tmp/foo
14917 @result{} ../share/dict/american-english
14918 @result{} ../../home/user/1.txt
14922 With @option{--relative-base}, relative file names are printed @emph{if}
14923 the resolved file name is below the given base directory. For files outside the
14924 base directory absolute file names are printed:
14928 realpath --relative-base=/usr \
14929 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14932 @result{} share/dict/american-english
14933 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
14937 When both @option{--relative-to=DIR1} and @option{--relative-base=DIR2}
14938 are used, file names are printed relative to @var{dir1} @emph{if} they are
14939 located below @var{dir2}. If the files are not below @var{dir2}, they are
14940 printed as absolute file names:
14944 realpath --relative-to=/usr/bin --relative-base=/usr \
14945 /usr/bin/sort /tmp/foo /usr/share/dict/words 1.txt
14948 @result{} ../share/dict/american-english
14949 @result{} /home/user/1.txt
14953 When both @option{--relative-to=DIR1} and @option{--relative-base=DIR2}
14954 are used, @var{dir1} @emph{must} be a subdirectory of @var{dir2}. Otherwise,
14955 @command{realpath} prints absolutes file names.
14958 @node Working context
14959 @chapter Working context
14961 @cindex working context
14962 @cindex commands for printing the working context
14964 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
14965 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
14966 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
14969 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
14970 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
14971 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
14972 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
14976 @node pwd invocation
14977 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
14980 @cindex print name of current directory
14981 @cindex current working directory, printing
14982 @cindex working directory, printing
14985 @command{pwd} prints the name of the current directory. Synopsis:
14988 pwd [@var{option}]@dots{}
14991 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
14998 If the contents of the environment variable @env{PWD} provide an
14999 absolute name of the current directory with no @samp{.} or @samp{..}
15000 components, but possibly with symbolic links, then output those
15001 contents. Otherwise, fall back to default @option{-P} handling.
15006 @opindex --physical
15007 Print a fully resolved name for the current directory. That is, all
15008 components of the printed name will be actual directory names -- none
15009 will be symbolic links.
15012 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
15013 If @option{-L} and @option{-P} are both given, the last one takes
15014 precedence. If neither option is given, then this implementation uses
15015 @option{-P} as the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
15016 environment variable is set.
15018 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{pwd}
15023 @node stty invocation
15024 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
15027 @cindex change or print terminal settings
15028 @cindex terminal settings
15029 @cindex line settings of terminal
15031 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
15035 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
15036 stty [@var{option}]
15039 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
15040 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
15041 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
15042 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
15043 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
15044 @option{--file} option.
15046 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
15047 the terminal line operation, as described below.
15049 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15056 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
15057 be used in combination with any line settings.
15059 @item -F @var{device}
15060 @itemx --file=@var{device}
15063 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
15064 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
15065 because opening a POSIX tty requires use of the
15066 @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to prevent a POSIX tty from blocking
15067 until the carrier detect line is high if
15068 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
15069 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
15075 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
15076 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
15077 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
15078 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
15082 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
15083 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
15084 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
15085 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
15088 Some settings are not available on all POSIX systems, since they use
15089 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with
15090 ``Non-POSIX'' in their description. On non-POSIX
15091 systems, those or other settings also may not
15092 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
15095 @command{stty} is installed only on platforms with the POSIX terminal
15096 interface, so portable scripts should not rely on its existence on
15097 non-POSIX platforms.
15102 * Control:: Control settings
15103 * Input:: Input settings
15104 * Output:: Output settings
15105 * Local:: Local settings
15106 * Combination:: Combination settings
15107 * Characters:: Special characters
15108 * Special:: Special settings
15113 @subsection Control settings
15115 @cindex control settings
15121 @cindex two-way parity
15122 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
15128 @cindex even parity
15129 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
15133 @cindex constant parity
15134 @cindex stick parity
15135 @cindex mark parity
15136 @cindex space parity
15137 Use "stick" (mark/space) parity. If parodd is set, the parity bit is
15138 always 1; if parodd is not set, the parity bit is always zero.
15139 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15146 @cindex character size
15147 @cindex eight-bit characters
15148 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
15153 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
15159 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
15163 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
15167 @cindex modem control
15168 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
15172 @cindex hardware flow control
15173 @cindex flow control, hardware
15174 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
15175 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15179 @cindex hardware flow control
15180 @cindex flow control, hardware
15181 @cindex DTR/DSR flow control
15182 Enable DTR/DSR flow control. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15187 @subsection Input settings
15189 @cindex input settings
15190 These settings control operations on data received from the terminal.
15195 @cindex breaks, ignoring
15196 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
15200 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
15201 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
15205 @cindex parity, ignoring
15206 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
15210 @cindex parity errors, marking
15211 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
15215 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
15219 @cindex eight-bit input
15220 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
15224 @cindex newline, translating to return
15225 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
15229 @cindex return, ignoring
15230 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
15234 @cindex return, translating to newline
15235 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
15239 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
15240 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
15244 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
15245 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
15246 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{Ctrl-S}/@kbd{Ctrl-Q}). May
15253 @cindex software flow control
15254 @cindex flow control, software
15255 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
15256 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
15257 empty again. May be negated.
15261 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
15262 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
15263 negated. Note ilcuc is not implemented, as one would not be able to issue
15264 almost any (lowercase) Unix command, after invoking it.
15268 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
15269 if negated). Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15273 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
15274 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
15275 when the input buffer is full. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15280 @subsection Output settings
15282 @cindex output settings
15283 These settings control operations on data sent to the terminal.
15288 Postprocess output. May be negated.
15292 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
15293 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-POSIX@. May be
15294 negated. (Note ouclc is not currently implemented.)
15298 @cindex return, translating to newline
15299 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15303 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
15304 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-POSIX@. May be
15309 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-POSIX@.
15314 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15318 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
15319 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays.
15325 @cindex pad character
15326 Use ASCII DEL characters for fill instead of
15327 ASCII NUL characters. Non-POSIX@.
15333 Newline delay style. Non-POSIX.
15340 Carriage return delay style. Non-POSIX.
15346 @opindex tab@var{n}
15347 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
15352 Backspace delay style. Non-POSIX.
15357 Vertical tab delay style. Non-POSIX.
15362 Form feed delay style. Non-POSIX.
15367 @subsection Local settings
15369 @cindex local settings
15374 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
15375 characters. May be negated.
15379 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
15380 special characters. May be negated.
15384 Enable non-POSIX special characters. May be negated.
15388 Echo input characters. May be negated.
15394 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
15399 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
15400 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
15404 @cindex newline, echoing
15405 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
15409 @cindex flushing, disabling
15410 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
15411 characters. May be negated.
15415 @cindex case translation
15416 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
15417 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
15418 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15422 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
15423 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-POSIX@.
15430 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
15431 Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15437 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
15438 @cindex hat notation for control characters
15439 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
15440 of literally. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15446 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
15447 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
15448 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings.
15454 Enable @samp{LINEMODE}, which is used to avoid echoing
15455 each character over high latency links. See also
15456 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc1116, Internet RFC 1116}.
15463 Note this setting is currently ignored on GNU/Linux systems.
15470 @subsection Combination settings
15472 @cindex combination settings
15473 Combination settings:
15480 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
15481 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
15485 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
15486 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
15490 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
15491 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
15495 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
15502 @c This is too long to write inline.
15504 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl
15505 icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl -noflsh
15506 -ixoff -iutf8 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel -xcase -olcuc -ocrnl
15507 opost -ofill onlcr -onocr -onlret nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0 ff0
15508 isig -tostop -ofdel -echoprt echoctl echoke -extproc
15512 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
15516 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
15517 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
15518 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
15519 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
15526 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
15527 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -icanon -opost
15528 -isig -iuclc -ixany -imaxbel -xcase min 1 time 0
15532 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
15536 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
15541 @cindex eight-bit characters
15542 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
15543 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
15547 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
15548 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
15552 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15556 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated. If negated, same
15563 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-POSIX@. May be negated.
15564 (Used for terminals with uppercase characters only.)
15568 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
15572 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
15577 @subsection Special characters
15579 @cindex special characters
15580 @cindex characters, special
15582 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
15583 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
15584 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
15585 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
15586 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
15587 any other digit to indicate decimal.
15589 @cindex disabling special characters
15590 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
15591 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
15592 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
15593 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
15594 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
15595 special character to @key{U}.)
15601 Send an interrupt signal.
15605 Send a quit signal.
15609 Erase the last character typed.
15613 Erase the current line.
15617 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
15625 Alternate character to end the line. Non-POSIX.
15630 Alternate character to toggle discarding of output. Non-POSIX.
15634 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-POSIX.
15638 Send an info signal. Not currently supported on GNU/Linux. Non-POSIX.
15642 Restart the output after stopping it.
15650 Send a terminal stop signal.
15654 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-POSIX.
15658 Redraw the current line. Non-POSIX.
15662 Erase the last word typed. Non-POSIX.
15666 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
15667 character. Non-POSIX.
15672 @subsection Special settings
15674 @cindex special settings
15679 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
15680 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
15684 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
15685 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
15687 @item ispeed @var{n}
15689 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
15691 @item ospeed @var{n}
15693 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
15697 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows.
15701 @itemx columns @var{n}
15704 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-POSIX.
15708 @cindex nonblocking @command{stty} setting
15709 Apply settings after first waiting for pending output to be transmitted.
15710 This is enabled by default for GNU @command{stty}.
15711 Note this is treated as an option rather than a line setting,
15712 and will follow the option processing rules described in the summary above.
15713 It is useful to disable this option
15714 in cases where the system may be in a state where serial transmission
15716 For example, if the system has received the @samp{DC3} character
15717 with @code{ixon} (software flow control) enabled, then @command{stty} would
15718 block without @code{-drain} being specified.
15719 May be negated. Non-POSIX.
15725 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
15726 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
15727 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
15728 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
15733 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-POSIX.
15737 Print the terminal speed.
15740 @cindex baud rate, setting
15741 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one of: 0
15742 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600 19200
15743 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as 19200;
15744 @code{extb} is the same as 38400. Many systems, including GNU/Linux,
15745 support higher speeds. The @command{stty} command includes support
15762 4000000 where the system supports these.
15763 0 hangs up the line if @option{-clocal} is set.
15767 @node printenv invocation
15768 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
15771 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
15772 @cindex environment variables, printing
15774 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
15777 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
15780 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
15781 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
15782 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
15784 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15792 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
15796 0 if all variables specified were found
15797 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
15798 2 if a write error occurred
15802 @node tty invocation
15803 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
15806 @cindex print terminal file name
15807 @cindex terminal file name, printing
15809 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
15810 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
15814 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
15817 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
15827 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
15831 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
15835 0 if standard input is a terminal
15836 1 if standard input is a non-terminal file
15837 2 if given incorrect arguments
15838 3 if a write error occurs
15842 @node User information
15843 @chapter User information
15845 @cindex user information, commands for
15846 @cindex commands for printing user information
15848 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
15849 logins, groups, and so forth.
15852 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
15853 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
15854 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
15855 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
15856 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
15857 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
15861 @node id invocation
15862 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
15865 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
15866 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
15867 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
15869 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
15870 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
15873 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user}]@dots{}
15876 @var{user} can be either a user ID or a name, with name look-up
15877 taking precedence unless the ID is specified with a leading @samp{+}.
15878 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
15880 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
15881 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
15882 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
15883 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
15884 In addition, if SELinux
15885 is enabled and the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is not set,
15886 then print @samp{context=@var{c}}, where @var{c} is the security context.
15888 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
15889 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
15891 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
15892 Also see @ref{Common options}.
15899 Print only the group ID.
15905 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
15911 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
15912 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
15918 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID@. Requires
15919 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
15925 Print only the user ID.
15932 @cindex security context
15933 Print only the security context of the process, which is generally
15934 the user's security context inherited from the parent process.
15935 If neither SELinux or SMACK is enabled then print a warning and
15936 set the exit status to 1.
15942 Delimit output items with ASCII NUL characters.
15943 This option is not permitted when using the default format.
15944 When multiple users are specified, and the @option{--groups} option
15945 is also in effect, groups are delimited with a single NUL character,
15946 while users are delimited with two NUL characters.
15951 users <NUL> devs <NUL>
15956 @macro primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{cmd,arg}
15957 Primary and supplementary groups for a process are normally inherited
15958 from its parent and are usually unchanged since login. This means
15959 that if you change the group database after logging in, @command{\cmd\}
15960 will not reflect your changes within your existing login session.
15961 Running @command{\cmd\} with a \arg\ causes the user and group
15962 database to be consulted afresh, and so will give a different result.
15964 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{id,user argument}
15968 @node logname invocation
15969 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
15972 @cindex printing user's login name
15973 @cindex login name, printing
15974 @cindex user name, printing
15977 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
15978 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
15979 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
15980 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
15981 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
15983 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
15989 @node whoami invocation
15990 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user name
15993 @cindex effective user name, printing
15994 @cindex printing the effective user ID
15996 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
15997 effective user ID@. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
15999 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16005 @node groups invocation
16006 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
16009 @cindex printing groups a user is in
16010 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
16012 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
16013 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
16014 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
16016 the list of that user's groups and the user name is separated from the
16017 group list by a colon. Synopsis:
16020 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
16023 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
16025 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16028 @primaryAndSupplementaryGroups{groups,list of users}
16032 @node users invocation
16033 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
16036 @cindex printing current usernames
16037 @cindex usernames, printing current
16039 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
16040 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
16041 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
16042 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
16043 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
16052 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
16053 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16054 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
16055 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
16057 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
16060 The @command{users} command is installed only on platforms with the
16061 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
16062 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16067 @node who invocation
16068 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
16071 @cindex printing current user information
16072 @cindex information, about current users
16074 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
16078 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
16081 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
16083 @cindex remote hostname
16084 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
16085 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
16086 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
16090 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
16091 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
16092 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
16093 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
16094 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
16098 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
16099 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
16100 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
16101 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
16104 Timestamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
16105 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
16106 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
16107 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
16109 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16117 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
16123 Print the date and time of last system boot.
16129 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
16135 Print a line of column headings.
16141 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
16142 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
16146 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
16147 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
16148 automatic dial-up internet access.
16152 Same as @samp{who am i}.
16158 List active processes spawned by init.
16164 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
16165 Overrides all other options.
16170 @opindex --runlevel
16171 Print the current (and maybe previous) run-level of the init process.
16175 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
16181 Print last system clock change.
16186 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
16187 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
16188 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
16199 @opindex --writable
16200 @cindex message status
16201 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
16202 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
16205 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
16206 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
16207 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
16212 The @command{who} command is installed only on platforms with the
16213 POSIX @code{<utmpx.h>} include file or equivalent, so portable scripts
16214 should not rely on its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
16219 @node System context
16220 @chapter System context
16222 @cindex system context
16223 @cindex context, system
16224 @cindex commands for system context
16226 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
16230 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
16231 * arch invocation:: Print machine hardware name.
16232 * nproc invocation:: Print the number of processors.
16233 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
16234 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
16235 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
16236 * uptime invocation:: Print system uptime and load.
16239 @node date invocation
16240 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
16243 @cindex time, printing or setting
16244 @cindex printing the current time
16249 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
16250 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
16251 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
16254 The @command{date} command displays the date and time.
16255 With the @option{--set} (@option{-s}) option, or with
16256 @samp{MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss]},
16257 it sets the date and time.
16260 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
16261 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
16262 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
16263 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Jul @ 9 17:00:00 EDT 2020}.
16266 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
16267 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
16268 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
16269 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
16274 * Date format specifiers:: Used in @samp{date '+...'}
16275 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
16276 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
16278 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
16280 * Examples of date:: Examples.
16283 @node Date format specifiers
16284 @subsection Specifying the format of @command{date} output
16286 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
16287 @cindex time formats
16288 @cindex formatting times
16289 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
16290 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
16291 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
16292 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
16293 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
16294 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
16298 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
16299 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
16300 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
16301 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
16304 @node Time conversion specifiers
16305 @subsubsection Time conversion specifiers
16307 @cindex time conversion specifiers
16308 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
16310 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
16314 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
16316 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
16318 hour, space padded (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}); equivalent to @samp{%_H}@.
16319 This is a GNU extension.
16321 hour, space padded (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}); equivalent to @samp{%_I}@.
16322 This is a GNU extension.
16324 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
16326 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
16327 This is a GNU extension.
16329 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
16330 blank in many locales.
16331 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
16333 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
16334 This is a GNU extension.
16336 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
16338 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
16340 @cindex Epoch, seconds since
16341 @cindex seconds since the Epoch
16342 @cindex beginning of time
16343 @cindex leap seconds
16344 seconds since the Epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC@.
16345 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
16346 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
16347 This is a GNU extension.
16349 @cindex leap seconds
16350 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
16351 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
16353 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
16355 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
16357 Four-digit numeric time zone, e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}, or
16359 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
16360 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
16361 by the @env{TZ} environment variable. A time zone is not determinable if
16362 its numeric offset is zero and its abbreviation begins with @samp{-}.
16363 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
16364 by the @option{--date} option.
16366 Numeric time zone with @samp{:}, e.g., @samp{-06:00} or
16367 @samp{+05:30}), or @samp{-00:00} if no time zone is determinable.
16368 This is a GNU extension.
16370 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
16371 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or @samp{-00:00:00} if no time zone is
16373 This is a GNU extension.
16375 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
16376 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or @samp{-00} if
16377 no time zone is determinable.
16378 This is a GNU extension.
16380 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
16381 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
16385 @node Date conversion specifiers
16386 @subsubsection Date conversion specifiers
16388 @cindex date conversion specifiers
16389 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
16391 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
16395 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
16397 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
16399 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
16401 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
16403 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2020})
16405 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
16406 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2019},
16407 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
16408 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
16410 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
16412 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
16414 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
16416 full date in ISO 8601 format; like @samp{%+4Y-%m-%d}
16417 except that any flags or field width override the @samp{+}
16418 and (after subtracting 6) the @samp{4}.
16419 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
16420 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
16423 year corresponding to the ISO week number, but without the century
16424 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
16425 as @samp{%y}, except that if the ISO week number (see
16427 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
16429 year corresponding to the ISO week number. This has the
16430 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the ISO
16432 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
16434 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
16435 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
16436 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
16440 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
16442 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
16444 quarter of year (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{4})
16446 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
16448 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
16449 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16450 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
16452 ISO week number, that is, the
16453 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
16454 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16455 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
16456 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
16457 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the ISO 8601
16460 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
16462 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
16463 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
16464 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
16466 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
16468 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
16470 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
16471 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
16472 precedes year @samp{0000}.
16476 @node Literal conversion specifiers
16477 @subsubsection Literal conversion specifiers
16479 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
16480 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
16482 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
16494 @node Padding and other flags
16495 @subsubsection Padding and other flags
16497 @cindex numeric field padding
16498 @cindex padding of numeric fields
16499 @cindex fields, padding numeric
16501 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
16502 with zeros, so that, for
16503 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
16504 Most numeric fields are padded on the left.
16505 However, nanoseconds are padded on the right since they are commonly
16506 used after decimal points in formats like @samp{%s.%-N}.
16507 Also, seconds since the Epoch are not padded
16508 since there is no natural width for them.
16510 The following optional flags can appear after the @samp{%}:
16514 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
16516 This is a GNU extension.
16517 As a special case, @samp{%-N} outputs only enough trailing digits to
16518 not lose information, assuming that the timestamp's resolution is the
16519 same as the current hardware clock. For example, if the hardware
16520 clock resolution is 1 microsecond, @samp{%s.%-N} outputs something
16521 like @samp{1640890100.395710}.
16524 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
16525 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
16526 This is a GNU extension.
16528 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
16529 would normally pad with spaces.
16531 Pad with zeros, like @samp{0}. In addition, precede any year number
16532 with @samp{+} if it exceeds 9999 or if its field width exceeds 4;
16533 similarly, precede any century number with @samp{+} if it exceeds 99
16534 or if its field width exceeds 2. This supports ISO 8601 formats
16535 for dates far in the future; for example, the command @code{date
16536 --date=12019-02-25 +%+13F} outputs the string @samp{+012019-02-25}.
16538 Use upper case characters if possible.
16539 This is a GNU extension.
16541 Use opposite case characters if possible.
16542 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
16543 This is a GNU extension.
16547 Here are some examples of padding:
16550 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
16552 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
16554 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
16558 You can optionally specify the field width
16559 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
16560 output of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
16561 the result is normally written right adjusted and padded to the given
16562 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
16563 a field of width 9. Nanoseconds are left adjusted, and are truncated
16564 or padded to the field width.
16566 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
16567 specification. The modifiers are:
16571 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
16572 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
16573 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
16574 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
16578 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
16579 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
16582 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
16583 is available, it is ignored.
16585 POSIX specifies the behavior of flags and field widths only for
16586 @samp{%C}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}, and @samp{%Y} (all without
16587 modifiers), and requires a flag to be present if and only if a field
16588 width is also present. Other combinations of flags, field widths and
16589 modifiers are GNU extensions.
16592 @node Setting the time
16593 @subsection Setting the time
16595 @cindex setting the time
16596 @cindex time setting
16597 @cindex appropriate privileges
16599 You must have appropriate privileges to set the
16600 system clock. For changes to persist across a reboot, the
16601 hardware clock may need to be updated from the system clock, which
16602 might not happen automatically on your system.
16604 To set the clock, you can use the @option{--set} (@option{-s}) option
16605 (@pxref{Options for date}). To set the clock without using GNU
16606 extensions, you can give @command{date} an argument of the form
16607 @samp{MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss]} where each two-letter
16608 component stands for two digits with the following meanings:
16620 first two digits of year (optional)
16622 last two digits of year (optional)
16627 Note, the @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be used with an
16628 argument in the above format. The @option{--universal} option may be used
16629 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
16630 relative to Universal Time rather than to the local time zone.
16633 @node Options for date
16634 @subsection Options for @command{date}
16636 @cindex @command{date} options
16637 @cindex options for @command{date}
16639 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
16640 Except for @option{-u}, these options are all GNU extensions to POSIX.
16642 All options that specify the date to display are mutually exclusive.
16643 I.e.: @option{--date}, @option{--file}, @option{--reference},
16644 @option{--resolution}.
16648 @item -d @var{datestr}
16649 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
16652 @cindex parsing date strings
16653 @cindex date strings, parsing
16654 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
16657 @opindex next @var{day}
16658 @opindex last @var{day}
16659 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
16660 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
16661 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
16662 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2020-07-21
16663 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
16664 489,392,193 nanoseconds after July 21, 2020 at 2:19:13 PM in a
16665 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of UTC.@*
16666 Note: input currently must be in locale independent format. E.g., the
16667 LC_TIME=C below is needed to print back the correct date in many locales:
16669 date -d "$(LC_TIME=C date)"
16671 @xref{Date input formats}.
16675 @cindex debugging date strings
16676 @cindex date strings, debugging
16677 @cindex arbitrary date strings, debugging
16678 Annotate the parsed date, display the effective time zone, and warn about
16681 @item -f @var{datefile}
16682 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
16685 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
16686 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
16687 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
16688 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
16691 @item -I[@var{timespec}]
16692 @itemx --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
16693 @opindex -I[@var{timespec}]
16694 @opindex --iso-8601[=@var{timespec}]
16695 Display the date using an ISO 8601 format, @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
16697 The argument @var{timespec} specifies the number of additional
16698 terms of the time to include. It can be one of the following:
16701 Print just the date. This is the default if @var{timespec} is omitted.
16702 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
16705 Also print hours and time zone.
16706 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H%:z}.
16709 Also print minutes.
16710 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M%:z}.
16713 Also print seconds.
16714 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M:%S%:z}.
16717 Also print nanoseconds.
16718 This is like the format @code{%Y-%m-%dT%H:%M:%S,%N%:z}.
16721 @macro dateParseNote
16722 This format is always suitable as input
16723 for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
16724 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
16728 @item -r @var{file}
16729 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
16731 @opindex --reference
16732 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
16733 instead of the current date and time.
16736 @opindex --resolution
16737 Display the timestamp resolution instead of the time.
16738 Current clock timestamps that are output by @command{date}
16739 are integer multiples of the timestamp resolution.
16740 With this option, the format defaults to @samp{%s.%N}.
16741 For example, if the clock resolution is 1 millisecond,
16751 @opindex --rfc-email
16752 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
16753 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
16757 Mon, 09 Jul 2020 17:00:00 -0400
16761 @opindex --rfc-2822
16762 This format conforms to Internet RFCs
16763 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc5322, 5322},
16764 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc2822, 2822} and
16765 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc822, 822}, the
16766 current and previous standards for Internet email.
16767 For compatibility with older versions of @command{date},
16768 @option{--rfc-2822} and @option{--rfc-822} are aliases for
16769 @option{--rfc-email}.
16771 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
16772 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
16773 Display the date using a format specified by
16774 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/search/rfc3339, Internet
16775 RFC 3339}. This is like @option{--iso-8601}, except that a space rather
16776 than a @samp{T} separates dates from times, and a period rather than
16777 a comma separates seconds from subseconds.
16780 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
16781 It can be one of the following:
16785 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2020-07-21}.
16786 This is like the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
16789 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
16790 @samp{2020-07-21 04:30:37+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
16791 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
16792 hours and thirty minutes east of UTC@. This is like
16793 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
16796 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
16797 @samp{2020-07-21 04:30:37.998458565+05:30}.
16798 This is like the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
16802 @item -s @var{datestr}
16803 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
16806 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
16807 See also @ref{Setting the time}.
16814 @opindex --universal
16815 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
16817 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
16819 @cindex leap seconds
16821 @cindex Universal Time
16822 Use Universal Time by operating as if the
16823 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
16824 UTC stands for Coordinated Universal Time, established in 1960.
16825 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (GMT) for
16826 historical reasons.
16827 Typically, systems ignore leap seconds and thus implement an
16828 approximation to UTC rather than true UTC.
16832 @node Examples of date
16833 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
16835 @cindex examples of @command{date}
16837 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
16838 option in the previous section.
16843 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
16846 date --date='2 days ago'
16850 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
16853 date --date='3 months 1 day'
16857 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
16860 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
16864 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
16870 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
16871 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
16872 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
16875 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
16876 of the month, you can use the (GNU extension)
16877 @samp{-} flag to suppress
16878 the padding altogether:
16881 date -d 1may '+%B %-d'
16885 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
16886 non-GNU versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
16889 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
16893 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
16896 date --set='+2 minutes'
16900 To print the date in Internet RFC 5322 format,
16901 use @samp{date --rfc-email}. Here is some example output:
16904 Tue, 09 Jul 2020 19:00:37 -0400
16907 @anchor{%s-examples}
16909 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the Epoch
16910 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
16911 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
16912 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
16913 number of the seconds since the Epoch for the time two minutes after the
16917 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
16921 To convert a date string from one time zone @var{from} to another @var{to},
16922 specify @samp{TZ="@var{from}"} in the environment and @samp{TZ="@var{to}"}
16923 in the @option{--date} option. @xref{Specifying time zone rules}.
16927 TZ="Asia/Tokyo" date --date='TZ="America/New_York" 2023-05-07 12:23'
16928 Mon May @ 8 01:23:00 JST 2023
16931 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
16932 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
16933 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
16934 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
16935 seconds) behind UTC:
16938 # local time zone used
16939 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
16944 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
16945 represented as seconds since the Epoch. But few people can look at
16946 the date @samp{1577836800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first
16947 second of the year 2020 in Greenwich, England.''
16950 date --date='2020-01-01 UTC' +%s
16954 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
16955 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
16956 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
16957 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
16958 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
16961 date -u --date=2020-07-21 +%s
16965 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
16966 a more readable form, use a command like this:
16969 date -d @@1595289600 +"%F %T %z"
16970 2020-07-20 20:00:00 -0400
16973 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
16976 date -u -d @@1595289600 +"%F %T %z"
16977 2020-07-21 00:00:00 +0000
16981 @cindex leap seconds
16982 Typically the seconds count omits leap seconds, but some systems are
16983 exceptions. Because leap seconds are not predictable, the mapping
16984 between the seconds count and a future timestamp is not reliable on
16985 the atypical systems that include leap seconds in their counts.
16987 Here is how the two kinds of systems handle the leap second at
16988 the end of the year 2016:
16991 # Typical systems ignore leap seconds:
16992 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
16994 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
16995 date: invalid date '2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000'
16996 date --date='2017-01-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
17001 # Atypical systems count leap seconds:
17002 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:59 +0000' +%s
17004 date --date='2016-12-31 23:59:60 +0000' +%s
17006 date --date='2017-01-01 00:00:00 +0000' +%s
17013 @node arch invocation
17014 @section @command{arch}: Print machine hardware name
17017 @cindex print machine hardware name
17018 @cindex system information, printing
17020 @command{arch} prints the machine hardware name,
17021 and is equivalent to @samp{uname -m}.
17025 arch [@var{option}]
17028 The program accepts the @ref{Common options} only.
17030 @command{arch} is not installed by default, so portable scripts should
17031 not rely on its existence.
17036 @node nproc invocation
17037 @section @command{nproc}: Print the number of available processors
17040 @cindex Print the number of processors
17041 @cindex system information, printing
17043 Print the number of processing units available to the current process,
17044 which may be less than the number of online processors.
17045 If this information is not accessible, then print the number of
17046 processors installed. If the @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} or @env{OMP_THREAD_LIMIT}
17047 environment variables are set, then they will determine the minimum
17048 and maximum returned value respectively. The result is guaranteed to be
17049 greater than zero. Synopsis:
17052 nproc [@var{option}]
17055 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17061 Print the number of installed processors on the system, which may
17062 be greater than the number online or available to the current process.
17063 The @env{OMP_NUM_THREADS} or @env{OMP_THREAD_LIMIT} environment variables
17064 are not honored in this case.
17066 @item --ignore=@var{number}
17068 If possible, exclude this @var{number} of processing units.
17075 @node uname invocation
17076 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
17079 @cindex print system information
17080 @cindex system information, printing
17082 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
17083 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
17084 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
17087 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
17090 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
17091 printed in this order:
17094 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
17095 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
17098 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
17099 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{kernel-version} is
17100 @samp{#1 SMP Fri Jul 17 17:18:38 UTC 2020}:
17104 @result{} Linux dumdum.example.org 5.9.16-200.fc33.x86_64@c
17105 #1 SMP Mon Dec 21 14:08:22 UTC 2020 x86_64 x86_64 x86_64 GNU/Linux
17109 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17117 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
17118 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
17121 @itemx --hardware-platform
17123 @opindex --hardware-platform
17124 @cindex implementation, hardware
17125 @cindex hardware platform
17126 @cindex platform, hardware
17127 Print the hardware platform name
17128 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
17129 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
17130 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
17136 @cindex machine type
17137 @cindex hardware class
17138 @cindex hardware type
17139 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
17145 @opindex --nodename
17148 @cindex network node name
17149 Print the network node hostname.
17154 @opindex --processor
17155 @cindex host processor type
17156 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
17157 architecture or ISA).
17158 Print @samp{unknown} if this information is not available.
17159 Note this is non-portable (even across GNU/Linux distributions).
17162 @itemx --operating-system
17164 @opindex --operating-system
17165 @cindex operating system name
17166 Print the name of the operating system.
17169 @itemx --kernel-release
17171 @opindex --kernel-release
17172 @cindex kernel release
17173 @cindex release of kernel
17174 Print the kernel release.
17177 @itemx --kernel-name
17179 @opindex --kernel-name
17180 @cindex kernel name
17181 @cindex name of kernel
17182 Print the kernel name.
17183 POSIX 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
17184 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
17185 POSIX specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
17186 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
17187 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
17188 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
17189 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
17193 @itemx --kernel-version
17195 @opindex --kernel-version
17196 @cindex kernel version
17197 @cindex version of kernel
17198 Print the kernel version.
17205 @node hostname invocation
17206 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
17209 @cindex setting the hostname
17210 @cindex printing the hostname
17211 @cindex system name, printing
17212 @cindex appropriate privileges
17214 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
17215 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
17216 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
17220 hostname [@var{name}]
17223 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
17226 @command{hostname} is not installed by default, and other packages
17227 also supply a @command{hostname} command, so portable scripts should
17228 not rely on its existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
17233 @node hostid invocation
17234 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier
17237 @cindex printing the host identifier
17239 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
17240 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
17241 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
17242 @xref{Common options}.
17244 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
17251 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
17252 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
17255 @command{hostid} is installed only on systems that have the
17256 @code{gethostid} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17261 @node uptime invocation
17262 @section @command{uptime}: Print system uptime and load
17265 @cindex printing the system uptime and load
17267 @command{uptime} prints the current time, the system's uptime, the
17268 number of logged-in users and the current load average.
17270 If an argument is specified, it is used as the file to be read
17271 to discover how many users are logged in. If no argument is
17272 specified, a system default is used (@command{uptime --help} indicates
17273 the default setting).
17275 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
17276 @xref{Common options}.
17278 For example, here's what it prints right now on one system I use:
17282 14:07 up 3:35, 3 users, load average: 1.39, 1.15, 1.04
17285 The precise method of calculation of load average varies somewhat
17286 between systems. Some systems calculate it as the average number of
17287 runnable processes over the last 1, 5 and 15 minutes, but some systems
17288 also include processes in the uninterruptible sleep state (that is,
17289 those processes which are waiting for device I/O). The Linux kernel
17290 includes uninterruptible processes.
17292 @command{uptime} is installed only on platforms with infrastructure
17293 for obtaining the boot time, and other packages also supply an
17294 @command{uptime} command, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17295 existence or on the exact behavior documented above.
17299 @node SELinux context
17300 @chapter SELinux context
17302 @cindex SELinux context
17303 @cindex SELinux, context
17304 @cindex commands for SELinux context
17306 This section describes commands for operations with SELinux
17310 * chcon invocation:: Change SELinux context of file
17311 * runcon invocation:: Run a command in specified SELinux context
17314 @node chcon invocation
17315 @section @command{chcon}: Change SELinux context of file
17318 @cindex changing security context
17319 @cindex change SELinux context
17321 @command{chcon} changes the SELinux security context of the selected files.
17325 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{context} @var{file}@dots{}
17326 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-l @var{range}]@c
17327 [-t @var{type}] @var{file}@dots{}
17328 chcon [@var{option}]@dots{} --reference=@var{rfile} @var{file}@dots{}
17331 Change the SELinux security context of each @var{file} to @var{context}.
17332 With @option{--reference}, change the security context of each @var{file}
17333 to that of @var{rfile}.
17335 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17339 @item --dereference
17340 @opindex --dereference
17341 Do not affect symbolic links but what they refer to; this is the default.
17344 @itemx --no-dereference
17346 @opindex --no-dereference
17347 @cindex no dereference
17348 Affect the symbolic links themselves instead of any referenced file.
17350 @item --reference=@var{rfile}
17351 @opindex --reference
17352 @cindex reference file
17353 Use @var{rfile}'s security context rather than specifying a @var{context} value.
17358 @opindex --recursive
17359 Operate on files and directories recursively.
17361 @item --preserve-root
17362 @opindex --preserve-root
17363 Refuse to operate recursively on the root directory, @file{/},
17364 when used together with the @option{--recursive} option.
17365 @xref{Treating / specially}.
17367 @item --no-preserve-root
17368 @opindex --no-preserve-root
17369 Do not treat the root directory, @file{/}, specially when operating
17370 recursively; this is the default.
17371 @xref{Treating / specially}.
17374 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17377 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17380 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
17387 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
17389 @item -u @var{user}
17390 @itemx --user=@var{user}
17393 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
17395 @item -r @var{role}
17396 @itemx --role=@var{role}
17399 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
17401 @item -t @var{type}
17402 @itemx --type=@var{type}
17405 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
17407 @item -l @var{range}
17408 @itemx --range=@var{range}
17411 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
17417 @node runcon invocation
17418 @section @command{runcon}: Run a command in specified SELinux context
17421 @cindex run with security context
17424 @command{runcon} runs file in specified SELinux security context.
17428 runcon @var{context} @var{command} [@var{args}]
17429 runcon [ -c ] [-u @var{user}] [-r @var{role}] [-t @var{type}]@c
17430 [-l @var{range}] @var{command} [@var{args}]
17433 Run @var{command} with completely-specified @var{context}, or with
17434 current or transitioned security context modified by one or more of @var{level},
17435 @var{role}, @var{type} and @var{user}.
17437 If none of @option{-c}, @option{-t}, @option{-u}, @option{-r}, or @option{-l}
17438 is specified, the first argument is used as the complete context.
17439 Any additional arguments after @var{command}
17440 are interpreted as arguments to the command.
17442 With neither @var{context} nor @var{command}, print the current
17445 @cindex restricted security context
17446 @cindex NO_NEW_PRIVS
17447 Note also the @command{setpriv} command which can be used to set the
17448 NO_NEW_PRIVS bit using @command{setpriv --no-new-privs runcon ...},
17449 thus disallowing usage of a security context with more privileges
17450 than the process would normally have.
17452 @command{runcon} accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17460 Compute process transition context before modifying.
17462 @item -u @var{user}
17463 @itemx --user=@var{user}
17466 Set user @var{user} in the target security context.
17468 @item -r @var{role}
17469 @itemx --role=@var{role}
17472 Set role @var{role} in the target security context.
17474 @item -t @var{type}
17475 @itemx --type=@var{type}
17478 Set type @var{type} in the target security context.
17480 @item -l @var{range}
17481 @itemx --range=@var{range}
17484 Set range @var{range} in the target security context.
17488 @cindex exit status of @command{runcon}
17492 125 if @command{runcon} itself fails
17493 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17494 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17495 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17498 @node Modified command invocation
17499 @chapter Modified command invocation
17501 @cindex modified command invocation
17502 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
17503 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
17505 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
17506 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
17510 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
17511 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
17512 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
17513 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
17514 * stdbuf invocation:: Modify buffering of standard streams.
17515 * timeout invocation:: Run with time limit.
17519 @node chroot invocation
17520 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
17523 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
17524 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
17526 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
17527 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.@footnote{However,
17528 some systems (e.g., FreeBSD) can be configured to allow certain regular
17529 users to use the @code{chroot} system call, and hence to run this program.
17530 Also, on Cygwin, anyone can run the @command{chroot} command, because the
17531 underlying function is non-privileged due to lack of support in MS-Windows.
17532 Furthermore, the @command{chroot} command avoids the @code{chroot} system call
17533 when @var{newroot} is identical to the old @file{/} directory for consistency
17534 with systems where this is allowed for non-privileged users.}.
17538 chroot @var{option} @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
17539 chroot @var{option}
17542 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
17543 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
17544 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist), then changes the working
17545 directory to @file{/}, and finally runs @var{command} with optional @var{args}.
17546 If @var{command} is not specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL}
17547 environment variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the
17548 @option{-i} option.
17549 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
17550 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
17552 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17553 Options must precede operands.
17557 @item --groups=@var{groups}
17559 Use this option to override the supplementary @var{groups} to be
17560 used by the new process.
17561 The items in the list (names or numeric IDs) must be separated by commas.
17562 Use @samp{--groups=''} to disable the supplementary group look-up
17563 implicit in the @option{--userspec} option.
17565 @item --userspec=@var{user}[:@var{group}]
17566 @opindex --userspec
17567 By default, @var{command} is run with the same credentials
17568 as the invoking process.
17569 Use this option to run it as a different @var{user} and/or with a
17570 different primary @var{group}.
17571 If a @var{user} is specified then the supplementary groups
17572 are set according to the system defined list for that user,
17573 unless overridden with the @option{--groups} option.
17576 @opindex --skip-chdir
17577 Use this option to not change the working directory to @file{/} after changing
17578 the root directory to @var{newroot}, i.e., inside the chroot.
17579 This option is only permitted when @var{newroot} is the old @file{/} directory,
17580 and therefore is mostly useful together with the @option{--groups} and
17581 @option{--userspec} options to retain the previous working directory.
17585 The user and group name look-up performed by the @option{--userspec}
17586 and @option{--groups} options, is done both outside and inside
17587 the chroot, with successful look-ups inside the chroot taking precedence.
17588 If the specified user or group items are intended to represent a numeric ID,
17589 then a name to ID resolving step is avoided by specifying a leading @samp{+}.
17590 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
17592 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
17593 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
17594 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
17595 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
17596 your new root directory.
17598 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
17599 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
17602 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
17605 Then you'll see output like this:
17610 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
17613 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
17614 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
17615 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
17616 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
17617 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
17618 device files), copy them into place, too.
17620 @command{chroot} is installed only on systems that have the
17621 @code{chroot} function, so portable scripts should not rely on its
17624 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
17628 125 if @command{chroot} itself fails
17629 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17630 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17631 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17635 @node env invocation
17636 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
17639 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
17640 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
17641 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
17643 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
17646 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17647 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
17648 env -[v]S'[@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17649 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]'
17653 @command{env} is commonly used on first line of scripts (shebang line):
17655 #!/usr/bin/env @var{command}
17656 #!/usr/bin/env -[v]S[@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
17657 @var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}
17660 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
17661 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
17662 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
17663 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
17664 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
17665 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
17667 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
17668 characters other than @samp{=} and ASCII NUL.
17669 However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
17670 consist solely of underscores, digits, and ASCII letters,
17671 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
17672 work well with other names.
17675 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
17676 specifies the program to invoke; it is
17677 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
17678 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
17679 The program should not be a special built-in utility
17680 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
17682 Modifications to @env{PATH} take effect prior to searching for
17683 @var{command}. Use caution when reducing @env{PATH}; behavior is
17684 not portable when @env{PATH} is undefined or omits key directories
17685 such as @file{/bin}.
17687 In the rare case that a utility contains a @samp{=} in the name, the
17688 only way to disambiguate it from a variable assignment is to use an
17689 intermediate command for @var{command}, and pass the problematic
17690 program name via @var{args}. For example, if @file{./prog=} is an
17691 executable in the current @env{PATH}:
17694 env prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
17695 env ./prog= true # runs 'true', with ./prog= in environment
17696 env -- prog= true # runs 'true', with prog= in environment
17697 env sh -c '\prog= true' # runs 'prog=' with argument 'true'
17698 env sh -c 'exec "$@@"' sh prog= true # also runs 'prog='
17701 @cindex environment, printing
17703 If no command name is specified following the environment
17704 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
17705 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
17707 For some examples, suppose the environment passed to @command{env}
17708 contains @samp{LOGNAME=rms}, @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and
17709 @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}:
17714 Output the current environment.
17716 $ env | LC_ALL=C sort
17719 PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks
17723 Run @command{foo} with a reduced environment, preserving only the
17724 original @env{PATH} to avoid problems in locating @command{foo}.
17726 env - PATH="$PATH" foo
17730 Run @command{foo} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=rms},
17731 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, and @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and guarantees
17732 that @command{foo} was found in the file system rather than as a shell
17739 Run @command{nemacs} with the environment containing @samp{LOGNAME=foo},
17740 @samp{EDITOR=emacs}, @samp{PATH=.:/gnubin:/hacks}, and
17741 @samp{DISPLAY=gnu:0}.
17743 env DISPLAY=gnu:0 LOGNAME=foo nemacs
17747 Attempt to run the program @command{/energy/--} (as that is the only
17748 possible path search result); if the command exists, the environment
17749 will contain @samp{LOGNAME=rms} and @samp{PATH=/energy}, and the
17750 arguments will be @samp{e=mc2}, @samp{bar}, and @samp{baz}.
17752 env -u EDITOR PATH=/energy -- e=mc2 bar baz
17758 @subsection General options
17760 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
17761 Options must precede operands.
17767 @item -u @var{name}
17768 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
17771 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
17776 @itemx --ignore-environment
17779 @opindex --ignore-environment
17780 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
17783 @itemx --chdir=@var{dir}
17786 Change the working directory to @var{dir} before invoking @var{command}.
17787 This differs from the shell built-in @command{cd} in that it starts
17788 @var{command} as a subprocess rather than altering the shell's own working
17789 directory; this allows it to be chained with other commands that run commands
17790 in a different context. For example:
17793 # Run 'true' with /chroot as its root directory and /srv as its working
17795 chroot /chroot env --chdir=/srv true
17796 # Run 'true' with /build as its working directory, FOO=bar in its
17797 # environment, and a time limit of five seconds.
17798 env --chdir=/build FOO=bar timeout 5 true
17801 @item --default-signal[=@var{sig}]
17802 Unblock and reset signal @var{sig} to its default signal handler.
17803 Without @var{sig} all known signals are unblocked and reset to their defaults.
17804 Multiple signals can be comma-separated. An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op.
17805 The following command runs @command{seq} with SIGINT and SIGPIPE set to their
17806 default (which is to terminate the program):
17809 env --default-signal=PIPE,INT seq 1000 | head -n1
17812 In the following example, we see how this is not
17813 possible to do with traditional shells.
17814 Here the first trap command sets SIGPIPE to ignore.
17815 The second trap command ostensibly sets it back to its default,
17816 but POSIX mandates that the shell must not change inherited
17817 state of the signal -- so it is a no-op.
17820 trap '' PIPE && sh -c 'trap - PIPE ; seq inf | head -n1'
17823 Using @option{--default-signal=PIPE} we can
17824 ensure the signal handling is set to its default behavior:
17827 trap '' PIPE && sh -c 'env --default-signal=PIPE seq inf | head -n1'
17831 @item --ignore-signal[=@var{sig}]
17832 Ignore signal @var{sig} when running a program. Without @var{sig} all
17833 known signals are set to ignore. Multiple signals can be comma-separated.
17834 An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op. The following command runs @command{seq}
17835 with SIGINT set to be ignored -- pressing @kbd{Ctrl-C} will not terminate it:
17838 env --ignore-signal=INT seq inf > /dev/null
17841 @samp{SIGCHLD} is special, in that @option{--ignore-signal=CHLD} might have
17842 no effect (POSIX says it's unspecified).
17844 Most operating systems do not allow ignoring @samp{SIGKILL}, @samp{SIGSTOP}
17845 (and possibly other signals). Attempting to ignore these signals will fail.
17847 Multiple (and contradictory) @option{--default-signal=SIG} and
17848 @option{--ignore-signal=SIG} options are processed left-to-right,
17849 with the latter taking precedence. In the following example, @samp{SIGPIPE} is
17850 set to default while @samp{SIGINT} is ignored:
17853 env --default-signal=INT,PIPE --ignore-signal=INT
17856 @item --block-signal[=@var{sig}]
17857 Block signal(s) @var{sig} from being delivered. Without @var{sig} all
17858 known signals are set to blocked. Multiple signals can be comma-separated.
17859 An empty @var{sig} argument is a no-op.
17861 @item --list-signal-handling
17862 List blocked or ignored signals to standard error, before executing a command.
17868 Show verbose information for each processing step.
17871 $ env -v -uTERM A=B uname -s
17880 When combined with @option{-S} it is recommended to list @option{-v}
17881 first, e.g. @command{env -vS'string'}.
17883 @item -S @var{string}
17884 @itemx --split-string=@var{string}
17886 @opindex --split-string
17887 @cindex shebang arguments
17888 @cindex scripts arguments
17889 @cindex env in scripts
17890 process and split @var{string} into separate arguments used to pass
17891 multiple arguments on shebang lines. @command{env} supports FreeBSD's
17892 syntax of several escape sequences and environment variable
17893 expansions. See below for details and examples.
17897 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
17901 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
17902 125 if @command{env} itself fails
17903 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
17904 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
17905 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
17908 @subsection @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} usage in scripts
17910 The @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} option enables use of multiple
17911 arguments on the first line of scripts (the shebang line, @samp{#!}).
17913 When a script's interpreter is in a known location, scripts typically
17914 contain the absolute file name in their first line:
17916 @multitable {Python Script:} {#!/usr/bin/python3}
17917 @item Shell script:
17931 @item Python script:
17940 When a script's interpreter is in a non-standard location
17941 in the @env{PATH} environment variable, it is recommended
17942 to use @command{env} on the first line of the script to
17943 find the executable and run it:
17945 @multitable {Python Script:} {#!/usr/bin/env python3}
17946 @item Shell script:
17949 #!/usr/bin/env bash
17956 #!/usr/bin/env perl
17960 @item Python script:
17963 #!/usr/bin/env python3
17969 Most operating systems (e.g. GNU/Linux, BSDs) treat all text after the
17970 first space as a single argument. When using @command{env} in a script
17971 it is thus not possible to specify multiple arguments.
17973 In the following example:
17975 #!/usr/bin/env perl -T -w
17979 The operating system treats @samp{perl -T -w} as one argument (the
17980 program's name), and executing the script fails with:
17983 /usr/bin/env: 'perl -T -w': No such file or directory
17986 The @option{-S} option instructs @command{env} to split the single string
17987 into multiple arguments. The following example works as expected:
17991 #!/usr/bin/env -S perl -T -w
17994 $ chmod a+x hello.pl
17999 And is equivalent to running @command{perl -T -w hello.pl} on the command line
18002 @unnumberedsubsubsec Testing and troubleshooting
18004 @cindex single quotes, and @command{env -S}
18005 @cindex @command{env -S}, and single quotes
18006 @cindex @option{-S}, env and single quotes
18007 To test @command{env -S} on the command line, use single quotes for the
18008 @option{-S} string to emulate a single parameter. Single quotes are not
18009 needed when using @command{env -S} in a shebang line on the first line of a
18010 script (the operating system already treats it as one argument).
18012 The following command is equivalent to the @file{hello.pl} script above:
18015 $ env -S'perl -T -w' hello.pl
18018 @cindex @command{env -S}, debugging
18019 @cindex debugging, @command{env -S}
18021 To troubleshoot @option{-S} usage add the @option{-v} as the first
18022 argument (before @option{-S}).
18024 Using @option{-vS} on a shebang line in a script:
18027 $ cat hello-debug.pl
18028 #!/usr/bin/env -vS perl -T -w
18031 $ chmod a+x hello-debug.pl
18033 split -S: 'perl -T -w'
18041 arg[3]= './hello-debug.pl'
18045 Using @option{-vS} on the command line prompt (adding single quotes):
18048 $ env -vS'perl -T -w' hello-debug.pl
18049 split -S: 'perl -T -w'
18057 arg[3]= 'hello-debug.pl'
18061 @subsection @option{-S}/@option{--split-string} syntax
18063 @unnumberedsubsubsec Splitting arguments by whitespace
18065 Running @command{env -Sstring} splits the @var{string} into
18066 arguments based on unquoted spaces or tab characters.
18067 (Newlines, carriage returns, vertical tabs and form feeds are treated
18068 like spaces and tabs.)
18070 In the following contrived example the @command{awk} variable
18071 @samp{OFS} will be @code{<space>xyz<space>} as these spaces are inside
18072 double quotes. The other space characters are used as argument separators:
18076 #!/usr/bin/env -S awk -v OFS=" xyz " -f
18077 BEGIN @{print 1,2,3@}
18079 $ chmod a+x one.awk
18084 When using @option{-S} on the command line prompt, remember to add
18085 single quotes around the entire string:
18088 $ env -S'awk -v OFS=" xyz " -f' one.awk
18092 @unnumberedsubsubsec Escape sequences
18094 @command{env} supports several escape sequences. These sequences
18095 are processed when unquoted or inside double quotes (unless otherwise noted).
18096 Single quotes disable escape sequences except @samp{\'} and @samp{\\}.
18098 @multitable @columnfractions .10 .90
18101 @tab Ignore the remaining characters in the string.
18102 Cannot be used inside double quotes.
18105 @tab form-feed character (ASCII 0x0C)
18108 @tab new-line character (ASCII 0x0A)
18111 @tab carriage-return character (ASCII 0x0D)
18114 @tab tab character (ASCII 0x09)
18117 @tab vertical tab character (ASCII 0x0B)
18120 @tab A hash @samp{#} character. Used when a @samp{#} character
18121 is needed as the first character of an argument (see 'comments' section
18125 @tab A dollar-sign character @samp{$}. Unescaped @samp{$} characters
18126 are used to expand environment variables (see 'variables' section below).
18129 @tab Inside double-quotes, replaced with a single space character.
18130 Outside quotes, treated as an argument separator. @samp{\_} can be used
18131 to avoid space characters in a shebang line (see examples below).
18134 @tab A double-quote character.
18137 @tab A single-quote character.
18138 This escape sequence works inside single-quoted strings.
18141 @tab A backslash character.
18142 This escape sequence works inside single-quoted strings.
18146 The following @command{awk} script will use tab character as input and output
18147 field separator (instead of spaces and tabs):
18151 #!/usr/bin/env -S awk -v FS="\t" -v OFS="\t" -f
18155 @unnumberedsubsubsec Comments
18157 The escape sequence @samp{\c} (used outside single/double quotes)
18158 causes @command{env} to ignore the rest of the string.
18160 The @samp{#} character causes @command{env} to ignore the rest of
18161 the string when it appears as the first character of an argument.
18162 Use @samp{\#} to reverse this behavior.
18165 $ env -S'printf %s\n A B C'
18170 $ env -S'printf %s\n A# B C'
18175 $ env -S'printf %s\n A #B C'
18178 $ env -S'printf %s\n A \#B C'
18183 $ env -S'printf %s\n A\cB C'
18187 NOTE: The above examples use single quotes as they are executed
18188 on the command-line.
18192 @unnumberedsubsubsec Environment variable expansion
18194 The pattern @samp{$@{VARNAME@}} is used to substitute a value from
18195 the environment variable. The pattern must include the curly braces
18196 (@samp{@{},@samp{@}}). Without them @command{env} will reject the string.
18197 Special shell variables (such as @samp{$@@}, @samp{$*}, @samp{$$}) are
18200 If the environment variable is empty or not set, the pattern will be replaced
18201 by an empty string. The value of @samp{$@{VARNAME@}} will be that of
18202 the executed @command{env}, before any modifications using
18203 @option{-i}/@option{--ignore-environment}/@option{-u}/@option{--unset} or
18204 setting new values using @samp{VAR=VALUE}.
18206 The following python script prepends @file{/opt/custom/modules} to the python
18207 module search path environment variable (@samp{PYTHONPATH}):
18211 #!/usr/bin/env -S PYTHONPATH=/opt/custom/modules/:$@{PYTHONPATH@} python
18216 The expansion of @samp{$@{PYTHONPATH@}} is performed by @command{env},
18217 not by a shell. If the curly braces are omitted, @command{env} will fail:
18221 #!/usr/bin/env -S PYTHONPATH=/opt/custom/modules/:$PYTHONPATH python
18225 $ chmod a+x custom.py
18227 /usr/bin/env: only $@{VARNAME@} expansion is supported, error at: $PYTHONPATH @c
18231 Environment variable expansion happens before clearing the environment
18232 (with @option{-i}) or unsetting specific variables (with @option{-u}):
18235 $ env -S'-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18239 Use @option{-v} to diagnose the operations step-by-step:
18242 $ env -vS'-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18243 expanding $@{USER@} into 'gordon'
18244 split -S: '-i OLDUSER=$@{USER@} env'
18249 setenv: OLDUSER=gordon
18257 @node nice invocation
18258 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
18262 @cindex scheduling, affecting
18263 @cindex appropriate privileges
18265 @command{nice} prints a process's @dfn{niceness}, or runs
18266 a command with modified niceness. @dfn{niceness} affects how
18267 favorably the process is scheduled in the system.
18271 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
18274 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
18275 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
18276 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
18278 Niceness values range at least from @minus{}20 (process has high priority
18279 and gets more resources, thus slowing down other processes) through 19
18280 (process has lower priority and runs slowly itself, but has less impact
18281 on the speed of other running processes). Some systems
18282 may have a wider range of niceness values; conversely, other systems may
18283 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
18284 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
18285 minimum or maximum supported value.
18287 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
18288 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
18289 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
18290 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
18291 terminology, POSIX defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
18292 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the non-negative difference
18293 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
18294 conforms to POSIX, its documentation and diagnostics use the
18295 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
18297 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18298 built-in utilities}).
18300 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{nice}
18302 Note to change the @dfn{niceness} of an existing process,
18303 one needs to use the @command{renice} command.
18305 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18306 Options must precede operands.
18309 @item -n @var{adjustment}
18310 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
18312 @opindex --adjustment
18313 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
18314 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
18315 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
18318 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
18319 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
18320 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
18324 @command{nice} is installed only on systems that have the POSIX
18325 @code{setpriority} function, so portable scripts should not rely on
18326 its existence on non-POSIX platforms.
18328 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
18332 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
18333 125 if @command{nice} itself fails
18334 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18335 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18336 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18339 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
18342 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
18345 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
18346 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
18348 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
18359 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
18360 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
18361 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
18365 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
18369 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
18370 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
18373 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
18377 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
18381 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
18383 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
18388 @node nohup invocation
18389 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
18392 @cindex hangups, immunity to
18393 @cindex immunity to hangups
18394 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
18397 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
18398 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
18402 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18405 If standard input is a terminal, redirect it so that terminal sessions
18406 do not mistakenly consider the terminal to be used by the command.
18407 Make the substitute file descriptor unreadable, so that commands that
18408 mistakenly attempt to read from standard input can report an error.
18409 This redirection is a GNU extension; programs intended to be portable
18410 to non-GNU hosts can use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18411 0>/dev/null} instead.
18414 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
18415 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
18416 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
18417 command is not run.
18418 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
18419 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
18420 regardless of the current umask settings.
18422 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
18423 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
18424 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
18425 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
18426 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
18428 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
18429 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
18433 nohup make > make.log
18436 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
18437 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
18438 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
18439 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
18440 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
18442 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18443 built-in utilities}).
18445 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
18446 options}. Options must precede operands.
18448 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
18452 125 if @command{nohup} itself fails, and @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set
18453 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18454 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18455 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18458 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, internal failures give status 127
18462 @node stdbuf invocation
18463 @section @command{stdbuf}: Run a command with modified I/O stream buffering
18466 @cindex standard streams, buffering
18467 @cindex line buffered
18469 @command{stdbuf} allows one to modify the buffering operations of the
18470 three standard I/O streams associated with a program. Synopsis:
18473 stdbuf @var{option}@dots{} @var{command}
18476 @var{command} must start with the name of a program that
18479 uses the ISO C @code{FILE} streams for input/output (note the
18480 programs @command{dd} and @command{cat} don't do that),
18483 does not adjust the buffering of its standard streams (note the
18484 program @command{tee} is not in this category).
18487 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
18490 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18494 @item -i @var{mode}
18495 @itemx --input=@var{mode}
18498 Adjust the standard input stream buffering.
18500 @item -o @var{mode}
18501 @itemx --output=@var{mode}
18504 Adjust the standard output stream buffering.
18506 @item -e @var{mode}
18507 @itemx --error=@var{mode}
18510 Adjust the standard error stream buffering.
18514 The @var{mode} can be specified as follows:
18519 Set the stream to line buffered mode.
18520 In this mode data is coalesced until a newline is output or
18521 input is read from any stream attached to a terminal device.
18522 This option is invalid with standard input.
18525 Disable buffering of the selected stream.
18526 In this mode, data is output immediately and only the
18527 amount of data requested is read from input.
18528 Note the difference in function for input and output.
18529 Disabling buffering for input will not influence the responsiveness
18530 or blocking behavior of the stream input functions.
18531 For example @code{fread} will still block until @code{EOF} or error,
18532 even if the underlying @code{read} returns less data than requested.
18535 Specify the size of the buffer to use in fully buffered mode.
18536 @multiplierSuffixesNoBlocks{size}
18540 @command{stdbuf} is installed only on platforms that use the
18541 Executable and Linkable Format (ELF) and support the
18542 @code{constructor} attribute, so portable scripts should not rely on
18545 @cindex exit status of @command{stdbuf}
18549 125 if @command{stdbuf} itself fails
18550 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18551 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18552 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18556 @node timeout invocation
18557 @section @command{timeout}: Run a command with a time limit
18561 @cindex run commands with bounded time
18563 @command{timeout} runs the given @var{command} and kills it if it is
18564 still running after the specified time interval. Synopsis:
18567 timeout [@var{option}] @var{duration} @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
18570 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
18571 built-in utilities}).
18573 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18574 Options must precede operands.
18577 @item --preserve-status
18578 @opindex --preserve-status
18579 Return the exit status of the managed @var{command} on timeout, rather than
18580 a specific exit status indicating a timeout. This is useful if the
18581 managed @var{command} supports running for an indeterminate amount of time.
18584 @opindex --foreground
18585 Don't create a separate background program group, so that
18586 the managed @var{command} can use the foreground TTY normally.
18587 This is needed to support two situations when timing out commands,
18588 when not invoking @command{timeout} from an interactive shell.
18591 @var{command} is interactive and needs to read from the terminal for example
18593 the user wants to support sending signals directly to @var{command}
18594 from the terminal (like Ctrl-C for example)
18597 Note in this mode of operation, any children of @var{command}
18598 will not be timed out. Also SIGCONT will not be sent to @var{command},
18599 as it's generally not needed with foreground processes, and can
18600 cause intermittent signal delivery issues with programs that are monitors
18601 themselves (like GDB for example).
18603 @item -k @var{duration}
18604 @itemx --kill-after=@var{duration}
18606 @opindex --kill-after
18607 Ensure the monitored @var{command} is killed by also sending a @samp{KILL}
18610 The specified @var{duration} starts from the point in time when
18611 @command{timeout} sends the initial signal to @var{command}, i.e.,
18612 not from the beginning when the @var{command} is started.
18614 This option has no effect if either the main @var{duration}
18615 of the @command{timeout} command, or the @var{duration} specified
18616 to this option, is 0.
18618 This option may be useful if the selected signal did not kill the @var{command},
18619 either because the signal was blocked or ignored, or if the @var{command} takes
18620 too long (e.g. for cleanup work) to terminate itself within a certain amount
18623 @item -s @var{signal}
18624 @itemx --signal=@var{signal}
18627 Send this @var{signal} to @var{command} on timeout, rather than the
18628 default @samp{TERM} signal. @var{signal} may be a name like @samp{HUP}
18629 or a number. @xref{Signal specifications}.
18635 Diagnose to standard error, any signal sent upon timeout.
18639 @var{duration} is a floating point number in either the current or the
18640 C locale (@pxref{Floating point}) followed by an optional unit:
18642 @samp{s} for seconds (the default)
18643 @samp{m} for minutes
18647 A duration of 0 disables the associated timeout.
18648 Note that the actual timeout duration is dependent on system conditions,
18649 which should be especially considered when specifying sub-second timeouts.
18651 @cindex exit status of @command{timeout}
18655 124 if @var{command} times out, and @option{--preserve-status} is not specified
18656 125 if @command{timeout} itself fails
18657 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
18658 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
18659 137 if @var{command} or @command{timeout} is sent the KILL(9) signal (128+9)
18660 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
18663 In the case of the @samp{KILL(9)} signal, @command{timeout} returns with
18664 exit status 137, regardless of whether that signal is sent to @var{command}
18665 or to @command{timeout} itself, i.e., these cases cannot be distinguished.
18666 In the latter case, the @var{command} process may still be alive after
18667 @command{timeout} has forcefully been terminated.
18672 # Send the default TERM signal after 20s to a short-living 'sleep 1'.
18673 # As that terminates long before the given duration, 'timeout' returns
18674 # with the same exit status as the command, 0 in this case.
18677 # Send the INT signal after 5s to the 'sleep' command. Returns after
18678 # 5 seconds with exit status 124 to indicate the sending of the signal.
18679 timeout -s INT 5 sleep 20
18681 # Likewise, but the command ignoring the INT signal due to being started
18682 # via 'env --ignore-signal'. Thus, 'sleep' terminates regularly after
18683 # the full 20 seconds, still 'timeout' returns with exit status 124.
18684 timeout -s INT 5s env --ignore-signal=INT sleep 20
18686 # Likewise, but sending the KILL signal 3 seconds after the initial
18687 # INT signal. Hence, 'sleep' is forcefully terminated after about
18688 # 8 seconds (5+3), and 'timeout' returns with an exit status of 137.
18689 timeout -s INT -k 3s 5s env --ignore-signal=INT sleep 20
18692 @node Process control
18693 @chapter Process control
18695 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
18696 @cindex commands for controlling processes
18699 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
18703 @node kill invocation
18704 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
18707 @cindex send a signal to processes
18709 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
18710 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
18711 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
18714 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
18715 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
18718 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{kill}
18720 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
18721 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
18722 is @samp{TERM}@. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
18723 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
18724 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
18726 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
18727 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
18728 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
18729 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
18730 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
18731 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
18732 value of @var{pid}.
18734 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
18735 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
18738 If a negative @var{pid} argument is desired as the first one, it
18739 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
18740 POSIX, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
18741 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
18750 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
18751 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
18753 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
18754 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
18755 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
18756 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
18757 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
18758 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
18759 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
18760 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
18761 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
18762 and if there is no output error.
18764 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
18765 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
18767 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
18768 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
18769 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
18770 @samp{SIG}@. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
18771 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
18772 ambiguity with lower case option letters.
18773 @xref{Signal specifications}, for a list of supported
18774 signal names and numbers.
18779 @cindex delaying commands
18780 @cindex commands for delaying
18782 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
18785 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
18789 @node sleep invocation
18790 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
18793 @cindex delay for a specified time
18795 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
18796 the values of the command line arguments.
18800 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
18804 Each argument is a non-negative number followed by an optional unit; the default
18805 is seconds. The units are:
18818 Although portable POSIX scripts must give @command{sleep} a single
18819 non-negative integer argument without a suffix, GNU @command{sleep}
18820 also accepts two or more arguments, unit suffixes, and floating-point
18821 numbers in either the current or the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
18823 For instance, the following could be used to @command{sleep} for
18824 1 second, 234 milli-, 567 micro- and 890 nanoseconds:
18827 sleep 1234e-3 567.89e-6
18830 Also one could sleep indefinitely like:
18836 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
18839 @c sleep is a shell built-in at least with Solaris 11's /bin/sh
18840 @mayConflictWithShellBuiltIn{sleep}
18845 @node Numeric operations
18846 @chapter Numeric operations
18848 @cindex numeric operations
18849 These programs do numerically-related operations.
18852 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
18853 * numfmt invocation:: Reformat numbers.
18854 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
18858 @node factor invocation
18859 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
18862 @cindex prime factors
18864 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopsis:
18867 factor [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]@dots{}
18870 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
18871 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
18873 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18879 @opindex --exponents
18880 print factors in the form @math{p^e}, rather than repeating
18881 the prime @samp{p}, @samp{e} times. If the exponent @samp{e} is 1,
18882 then it is omitted.
18885 $ factor --exponents 3000
18890 If the number to be factored is small (less than @math{2^{127}} on
18891 typical machines), @command{factor} uses a faster algorithm.
18892 For example, on a circa-2017 Intel Xeon Silver 4116, factoring the
18893 product of the eighth and ninth Mersenne primes (approximately
18894 @math{2^{92}}) takes about 4 ms of CPU time:
18897 $ M8=$(echo 2^31-1 | bc)
18898 $ M9=$(echo 2^61-1 | bc)
18899 $ n=$(echo "$M8 * $M9" | bc)
18900 $ bash -c "time factor $n"
18901 4951760154835678088235319297: 2147483647 2305843009213693951
18908 For larger numbers, @command{factor} uses a slower algorithm. On the
18909 same platform, factoring the eighth Fermat number @math{2^{256} + 1}
18910 takes about 14 seconds, and the slower algorithm would have taken
18911 about 750 ms to factor @math{2^{127} - 3} instead of the 50 ms needed by
18912 the faster algorithm.
18914 Factoring large numbers is, in general, hard. The Pollard-Brent rho
18915 algorithm used by @command{factor} is particularly effective for
18916 numbers with relatively small factors. If you wish to factor large
18917 numbers which do not have small factors (for example, numbers which
18918 are the product of two large primes), other methods are far better.
18923 @node numfmt invocation
18924 @section @command{numfmt}: Reformat numbers
18928 @command{numfmt} reads numbers in various representations and reformats them
18929 as requested. The most common usage is converting numbers to/from @emph{human}
18930 representation (e.g. @samp{4G} @expansion{} @samp{4,000,000,000}).
18933 numfmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{number}]
18936 @command{numfmt} converts each @var{number} on the command-line according to the
18937 specified options (see below). If no @var{number}s are given, it reads numbers
18938 from standard input. @command{numfmt} can optionally extract numbers from
18939 specific columns, maintaining proper line padding and alignment.
18943 See @option{--invalid} for additional information regarding exit status.
18945 @subsection General options
18947 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
18953 Print (to standard error) warning messages about possible erroneous usage.
18956 @itemx --delimiter=@var{d}
18958 @opindex --delimiter
18959 Use the character @var{d} as input field separator (default: whitespace).
18960 @emph{Note}: Using non-default delimiter turns off automatic padding.
18962 @item --field=@var{fields}
18964 Convert the number in input field @var{fields} (default: 1).
18965 @var{fields} supports @command{cut} style field ranges:
18968 N N'th field, counted from 1
18969 N- from N'th field, to end of line
18970 N-M from N'th to M'th field (inclusive)
18971 -M from first to M'th field (inclusive)
18976 @item --format=@var{format}
18978 Use printf-style floating FORMAT string. The @var{format} string must contain
18979 one @samp{%f} directive, optionally with @samp{'}, @samp{-}, @samp{0}, width
18980 or precision modifiers. The @samp{'} modifier will enable @option{--grouping},
18981 the @samp{-} modifier will enable left-aligned @option{--padding} and the width
18982 modifier will enable right-aligned @option{--padding}. The @samp{0} width
18983 modifier (without the @samp{-} modifier) will generate leading zeros on the
18984 number, up to the specified width. A precision specification like @samp{%.1f}
18985 will override the precision determined from the input data or set due to
18986 @option{--to} option auto scaling.
18988 @item --from=@var{unit}
18990 Auto-scales input numbers according to @var{unit}. See UNITS below.
18991 The default is no scaling, meaning suffixes (e.g. @samp{M}, @samp{G}) will
18994 @item --from-unit=@var{n}
18995 @opindex --from-unit
18996 Specify the input unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
18997 the input numbers represent other units (e.g. if the input number @samp{10}
18998 represents 10 units of 512 bytes, use @samp{--from-unit=512}).
18999 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
19002 @opindex --grouping
19003 Group digits in output numbers according to the current locale's grouping rules
19004 (e.g @emph{Thousands Separator} character, commonly @samp{.} (dot) or @samp{,}
19005 comma). This option has no effect in @samp{POSIX/C} locale.
19007 @item --header[=@var{n}]
19009 @opindex --header=N
19010 Print the first @var{n} (default: 1) lines without any conversion.
19012 @item --invalid=@var{mode}
19014 The default action on input errors is to exit immediately with status code 2.
19015 @option{--invalid=@samp{abort}} explicitly specifies this default mode.
19016 With a @var{mode} of @samp{fail}, print a warning for @emph{each} conversion
19017 error, and exit with status 2. With a @var{mode} of @samp{warn}, exit with
19018 status 0, even in the presence of conversion errors, and with a @var{mode} of
19019 @samp{ignore} do not even print diagnostics.
19021 @item --padding=@var{n}
19023 Pad the output numbers to @var{n} characters, by adding spaces. If @var{n} is
19024 a positive number, numbers will be right-aligned. If @var{n} is a negative
19025 number, numbers will be left-aligned. By default, numbers are automatically
19026 aligned based on the input line's width (only with the default delimiter).
19028 @item --round=@var{method}
19030 @opindex --round=up
19031 @opindex --round=down
19032 @opindex --round=from-zero
19033 @opindex --round=towards-zero
19034 @opindex --round=nearest
19035 When converting number representations, round the number according to
19036 @var{method}, which can be @samp{up}, @samp{down},
19037 @samp{from-zero} (the default), @samp{towards-zero}, @samp{nearest}.
19039 @item --suffix=@var{suffix}
19041 Add @samp{SUFFIX} to the output numbers, and accept optional @samp{SUFFIX} in
19044 @item --to=@var{unit}
19046 Auto-scales output numbers according to @var{unit}. See @emph{Units} below.
19047 The default is no scaling, meaning all the digits of the number are printed.
19049 @item --to-unit=@var{n}
19051 Specify the output unit size (instead of the default 1). Use this option when
19052 the output numbers represent other units (e.g. to represent @samp{4,000,000}
19053 bytes in blocks of 1KB, use @samp{--to=si --to-unit=1000}).
19054 Suffixes are handled as with @samp{--from=auto}.
19057 @newlineFieldSeparator
19061 @subsection Possible @var{unit}s:
19063 The following are the possible @var{unit} options with @option{--from=UNITS} and
19064 @option{--to=UNITS}:
19069 No scaling is performed. For input numbers, no suffixes are accepted, and any
19070 trailing characters following the number will trigger an error. For output
19071 numbers, all digits of the numbers will be printed.
19074 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International System of Units (SI)}
19076 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19077 For output numbers, values larger than 1000 will be rounded, and printed with
19078 one of the following suffixes:
19081 @samp{K} => @math{1000^1 = 10^3} (Kilo)
19082 @samp{M} => @math{1000^2 = 10^6} (Mega)
19083 @samp{G} => @math{1000^3 = 10^9} (Giga)
19084 @samp{T} => @math{1000^4 = 10^{12}} (Tera)
19085 @samp{P} => @math{1000^5 = 10^{15}} (Peta)
19086 @samp{E} => @math{1000^6 = 10^{18}} (Exa)
19087 @samp{Z} => @math{1000^7 = 10^{21}} (Zetta)
19088 @samp{Y} => @math{1000^8 = 10^{24}} (Yotta)
19089 @samp{R} => @math{1000^9 = 10^{27}} (Ronna)
19090 @samp{Q} => @math{1000^{10} = 10^{30}} (Quetta)
19094 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
19095 Commission (IEC)} standard.
19096 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19097 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
19098 one of the following suffixes:
19101 @samp{K} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
19102 @samp{M} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
19103 @samp{G} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
19104 @samp{T} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
19105 @samp{P} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
19106 @samp{E} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
19107 @samp{Z} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
19108 @samp{Y} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
19109 @samp{R} => @math{1024^9 = 2^{90}} (Robi)
19110 @samp{Q} => @math{1024^{10} = 2^{100}} (Quebi)
19113 The @option{iec} option uses a single letter suffix (e.g. @samp{G}), which is
19114 not fully standard, as the @emph{iec} standard recommends a two-letter symbol
19115 (e.g @samp{Gi}) -- but in practice, this method is common. Compare with
19116 the @option{iec-i} option.
19119 Auto-scale numbers according to the @emph{International Electrotechnical
19120 Commission (IEC)} standard.
19121 For input numbers, accept one of the following suffixes.
19122 For output numbers, values larger than 1024 will be rounded, and printed with
19123 one of the following suffixes:
19126 @samp{Ki} => @math{1024^1 = 2^{10}} (Kibi)
19127 @samp{Mi} => @math{1024^2 = 2^{20}} (Mebi)
19128 @samp{Gi} => @math{1024^3 = 2^{30}} (Gibi)
19129 @samp{Ti} => @math{1024^4 = 2^{40}} (Tebi)
19130 @samp{Pi} => @math{1024^5 = 2^{50}} (Pebi)
19131 @samp{Ei} => @math{1024^6 = 2^{60}} (Exbi)
19132 @samp{Zi} => @math{1024^7 = 2^{70}} (Zebi)
19133 @samp{Yi} => @math{1024^8 = 2^{80}} (Yobi)
19134 @samp{Ri} => @math{1024^9 = 2^{90}} (Robi)
19135 @samp{Qi} => @math{1024^{10} = 2^{100}} (Quebi)
19138 The @option{iec-i} option uses a two-letter suffix symbol (e.g. @samp{Gi}),
19139 as the @emph{iec} standard recommends, but this is not always common in
19140 practice. Compare with the @option{iec} option.
19143 @samp{auto} can only be used with @option{--from}. With this method, numbers
19144 with single-letter suffixes like @samp{K}
19145 suffixes are interpreted as @emph{SI} values, and numbers with
19146 two-letter suffixes like @samp{Ki}
19147 are interpreted as @emph{IEC} values.
19151 @subsection Examples of using @command{numfmt}
19153 Converting a single number from/to @emph{human} representation:
19155 $ numfmt --to=si 500000
19158 $ numfmt --to=iec 500000
19161 $ numfmt --to=iec-i 500000
19164 $ numfmt --from=si 1M
19167 $ numfmt --from=iec 1M
19170 # with '--from=auto', M=Mega, Mi=Mebi
19171 $ numfmt --from=auto 1M
19173 $ numfmt --from=auto 1Mi
19177 Converting from @samp{SI} to @samp{IEC} scales (e.g. when a drive's capacity is
19178 advertised as @samp{1TB}, while checking the drive's capacity gives lower
19182 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec 1T
19186 With both input and output scales specified,
19187 the largest defined prefixes are supported:
19190 $ numfmt --from=si --to=iec-i 2000R
19194 Converting a single field from an input file / piped input (these contrived
19195 examples are for demonstration purposes only, as both @command{ls} and
19196 @command{df} support the @option{--human-readable} option to
19197 output sizes in human-readable format):
19200 # Third field (file size) will be shown in SI representation
19201 $ ls -log | numfmt --field 3 --header --to=si | head -n4
19202 -rw-r--r-- 1 94K Aug 23 2011 ABOUT-NLS
19203 -rw-r--r-- 1 3.7K Jan 7 16:15 AUTHORS
19204 -rw-r--r-- 1 36K Jun 1 2011 COPYING
19205 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jan 7 15:15 ChangeLog
19207 # Second field (size) will be shown in IEC representation
19208 $ df --block-size=1 | numfmt --field 2 --header --to=iec | head -n4
19209 File system 1B-blocks Used Available Use% Mounted on
19210 rootfs 132G 104741408 26554036 80% /
19211 tmpfs 794M 7580 804960 1% /run/shm
19212 /dev/sdb1 694G 651424756 46074696 94% /home
19216 Output can be tweaked using @option{--padding} or @option{--format}:
19219 # Pad to 10 characters, right-aligned
19220 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=10
19226 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned
19227 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding=-10
19233 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
19234 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --format="%10f"
19240 # Pad to 10 characters, left-aligned, using 'format'
19241 $ du -s * | numfmt --to=si --padding="%-10f"
19248 With locales that support grouping digits, using @option{--grouping} or
19249 @option{--format} enables grouping. In @samp{POSIX} locale, grouping is
19253 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19256 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19259 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --grouping 2G
19262 $ LC_ALL=C numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19265 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19268 $ LC_ALL=en_US.utf8 numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'-15f==" 2G
19271 $ LC_ALL=ta_IN numfmt --from=iec --format="==%'15f==" 2G
19272 == 2,14,74,83,648==
19276 @node seq invocation
19277 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
19280 @cindex numeric sequences
19281 @cindex sequence of numbers
19283 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
19286 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
19287 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
19288 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
19291 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
19292 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
19293 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
19294 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
19295 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
19296 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
19297 The sequence of numbers ends when the sum of the current number and
19298 @var{increment} would become greater than @var{last},
19299 so @code{seq 1 10 10} only produces @samp{1}.
19300 @var{increment} must not be @samp{0}; use the tool @command{yes} to get
19301 repeated output of a constant number.
19302 @var{first}, @var{increment} and @var{last} must not be @code{NaN},
19303 but @code{inf} is supported.
19304 Floating-point numbers may be specified in either the current or
19305 the C locale. @xref{Floating point}.
19307 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
19308 Options must precede operands.
19311 @item -f @var{format}
19312 @itemx --format=@var{format}
19315 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
19316 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
19317 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
19318 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
19319 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}@.
19320 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
19321 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
19322 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
19323 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
19324 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
19325 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
19327 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
19328 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
19329 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
19330 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
19331 the default format is @samp{%g}.
19333 @item -s @var{string}
19334 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
19336 @opindex --separator
19337 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
19338 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
19339 The output always terminates with a newline.
19342 @itemx --equal-width
19344 @opindex --equal-width
19345 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
19346 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
19347 decimal representation.
19348 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
19352 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
19355 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
19361 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
19362 to perform the conversion:
19365 $ printf '%x\n' $(seq 1048575 1024 1050623)
19371 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
19372 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
19375 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
19381 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
19384 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
19385 at least @math{2^{53}}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
19386 differ depending on your floating-point implementation.
19387 @xref{Floating point}. A common
19388 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @math{2^{64}},
19389 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
19392 $ seq 50000000000000000000 2 50000000000000000004
19393 50000000000000000000
19394 50000000000000000000
19395 50000000000000000004
19398 However, note that when limited to non-negative whole numbers,
19399 an increment of less than 200, and no format-specifying option,
19400 seq can print arbitrarily large numbers.
19401 Therefore @command{seq inf} can be used to
19402 generate an infinite sequence of numbers.
19404 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
19405 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
19406 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
19407 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
19410 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
19413 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
19418 @node File permissions
19419 @chapter File permissions
19423 @node File timestamps
19424 @chapter File timestamps
19430 Standard POSIX files have three timestamps: the access timestamp
19431 (atime) of the last read, the modification timestamp (mtime) of the
19432 last write, and the status change timestamp (ctime) of the last change
19433 to the file's meta-information. Some file systems support a
19434 fourth time: the birth timestamp (birthtime) of when the file was
19435 created; by definition, birthtime never changes.
19437 One common example of a ctime change is when the permissions of a file
19438 change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so atime
19439 doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime doesn't
19440 change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed, and this
19441 must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field. This is
19442 necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a fresh
19443 copy of the file, including the new permissions value. Another
19444 operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting the others is
19447 Naively, a file's atime, mtime, and ctime are set to the current time
19448 whenever you read, write, or change the attributes of the file
19449 respectively, and searching a directory counts as reading it. A
19450 file's atime and mtime can also be set directly, via the
19451 @command{touch} command (@pxref{touch invocation}). In practice,
19452 though, timestamps are not updated quite that way.
19454 For efficiency reasons, many systems are lazy about updating atimes:
19455 when a program accesses a file, they may delay updating the file's
19456 atime, or may not update the file's atime if the file has been
19457 accessed recently, or may not update the atime at all. Similar
19458 laziness, though typically not quite so extreme, applies to mtimes and
19461 Some systems emulate timestamps instead of supporting them directly,
19462 and these emulations may disagree with the naive interpretation. For
19463 example, a system may fake an atime or ctime by using the mtime.
19466 The determination of what time is ``current'' depends on the
19467 platform. Platforms with network file systems often use different
19468 clocks for the operating system and for file systems; because
19469 updates typically uses file systems' clocks by default, clock
19470 skew can cause the resulting file timestamps to appear to be in a
19471 program's ``future'' or ``past''.
19473 @cindex file timestamp resolution
19474 When the system updates a file timestamp to a desired time @var{t}
19475 (which is either the current time, or a time specified via the
19476 @command{touch} command), there are several reasons the file's
19477 timestamp may be set to a value that differs from @var{t}. First,
19478 @var{t} may have a higher resolution than supported. Second, a file
19479 system may use different resolutions for different types of times.
19480 Third, file timestamps may use a different resolution than operating
19481 system timestamps. Fourth, the operating system primitives used to
19482 update timestamps may employ yet a different resolution. For example,
19483 in theory a file system might use 10-microsecond resolution for access
19484 timestamp and 100-nanosecond resolution for modification timestamp, and the
19485 operating system might use nanosecond resolution for the current time
19486 and microsecond resolution for the primitive that @command{touch} uses
19487 to set a file's timestamp to an arbitrary value.
19490 @include parse-datetime.texi
19492 @include sort-version.texi
19496 @node Opening the software toolbox
19497 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
19499 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
19500 @uref{https://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
19501 @cite{What's GNU@?} column of the June 1994 @cite{Linux Journal}}.
19502 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
19505 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
19506 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
19507 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
19508 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
19509 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
19510 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
19511 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
19515 @node Toolbox introduction
19516 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
19518 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
19519 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system
19521 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
19522 of program development and usage.
19524 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
19525 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which GNU/Linux and GNU are
19526 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
19527 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
19528 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
19529 for solving many kinds of problems.
19531 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
19532 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
19533 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
19534 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
19535 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
19537 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
19538 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
19539 tools -- a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
19540 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
19541 with the handle of his screwdriver.
19543 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
19544 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
19545 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
19550 difficult to write,
19553 difficult to maintain and
19557 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
19560 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
19561 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
19562 simpler to design, write, and get right -- they only do one thing.
19564 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
19565 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
19566 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
19567 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
19568 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
19569 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
19570 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
19571 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
19572 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
19574 @node I/O redirection
19575 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
19577 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
19578 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
19579 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
19580 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
19581 data source is a regular file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
19582 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
19583 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
19584 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
19585 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
19588 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
19591 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
19594 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
19595 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
19596 it is in the desired form.
19598 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
19599 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
19600 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
19601 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
19602 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
19603 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
19604 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
19605 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
19606 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
19608 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
19609 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
19610 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
19611 lines delimited by the ASCII LF (Line Feed) character,
19612 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
19613 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
19614 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
19615 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
19616 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
19617 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
19618 data with a text editor.)
19620 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
19621 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
19622 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
19623 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
19624 for the full story.
19626 @node The who command
19627 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
19629 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
19630 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
19631 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
19636 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
19637 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
19638 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
19639 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
19642 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
19643 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
19644 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
19645 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
19646 but the data is not all that exciting.
19648 @node The cut command
19649 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
19651 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
19652 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
19653 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
19654 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
19658 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
19661 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
19664 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
19665 @print{} root:Operator
19667 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
19668 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
19672 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
19673 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
19674 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
19675 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
19677 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
19688 @node The sort command
19689 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
19691 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
19692 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
19693 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
19696 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
19697 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
19698 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
19699 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
19700 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
19703 @node The uniq command
19704 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
19706 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
19707 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
19708 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
19709 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
19710 standard input. It prints only one
19711 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
19712 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
19713 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
19716 @node Putting the tools together
19717 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
19719 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
19720 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a
19722 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
19723 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
19726 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
19727 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
19728 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
19729 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
19730 by generating just a list of logged on users:
19740 Next, sort the list:
19743 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
19750 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
19753 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
19759 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
19760 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
19761 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
19763 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it
19765 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
19766 or @code{root}, prompt):
19769 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
19770 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
19772 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
19775 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
19776 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
19777 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
19778 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
19779 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
19780 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
19781 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
19784 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
19785 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
19786 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
19788 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
19789 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
19790 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
19792 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
19793 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
19794 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
19797 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
19798 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
19800 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
19801 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
19802 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
19806 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
19807 @print{} this example has mixed case!
19810 There are several options of interest:
19814 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
19815 operations apply to characters not in the given set
19818 delete characters in the first set from the output
19821 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
19824 We will be using all three options in a moment.
19826 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
19827 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
19828 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
19829 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
19830 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
19831 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
19832 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
19854 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
19855 instead of a regular file.
19857 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
19858 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
19861 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
19862 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
19865 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
19868 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
19869 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
19873 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
19876 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
19877 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
19878 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
19879 be left alone. (The ASCII tab character should also be included for
19880 good measure in a production script.)
19882 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
19883 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
19884 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
19885 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
19888 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19889 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
19892 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
19893 multiple newline characters in the output into just one, removing
19894 blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
19895 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
19896 typing in all of a command.)
19898 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
19899 case. We're ready to count each word:
19902 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19903 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
19906 At this point, the data might look something like this:
19919 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
19920 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
19921 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
19925 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
19928 reverse the order of the sort
19931 The final pipeline looks like this:
19934 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19935 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
19944 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
19945 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
19946 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
19947 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
19949 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
19950 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
19951 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
19952 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
19953 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/share/dict/words}.
19955 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
19956 a sorted list of words, one per line:
19959 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19960 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
19963 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
19964 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
19965 Unfortunately @command{comm} operates on sorted input and
19966 @file{/usr/share/dict/words} is not sorted the way that @command{sort}
19967 and @command{comm} normally use, so we first create a properly-sorted
19968 copy of the dictionary and then run a pipeline that uses the copy.
19971 $ sort /usr/share/dict/words > sorted-words
19972 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
19973 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
19974 > comm -23 - sorted-words
19977 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
19978 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
19979 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
19980 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
19981 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
19982 spelling checker on Unix.
19984 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
19988 search files for text that matches a regular expression
19991 count lines, words, characters
19994 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
19997 the stream editor, an advanced tool
20000 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
20003 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
20004 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
20005 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
20006 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
20012 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
20015 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
20016 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
20017 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
20020 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
20021 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
20024 Let someone else do the hard part.
20027 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
20028 appropriate tool, build one.
20031 All the programs discussed are available as described in
20032 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/software/coreutils/coreutils.html,
20033 GNU core utilities}.
20035 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
20036 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
20037 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
20038 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
20039 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
20040 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
20041 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
20042 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
20043 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
20046 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
20047 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
20048 still in print and are well worth
20049 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
20050 how I view programming.
20052 The programs in both books are available from
20053 @uref{https://www.cs.princeton.edu/~bwk/, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
20054 For a number of years, there was an active
20055 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
20056 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
20057 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
20058 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
20060 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
20061 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
20062 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
20063 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
20064 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
20066 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
20067 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
20069 @node GNU Free Documentation License
20070 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
20074 @node Concept index
20081 @c Local variables:
20082 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32